PostgreSQL Source Code git master
xlog.c File Reference
#include "postgres.h"
#include <ctype.h>
#include <math.h>
#include <time.h>
#include <fcntl.h>
#include <sys/stat.h>
#include <unistd.h>
#include "access/clog.h"
#include "access/commit_ts.h"
#include "access/heaptoast.h"
#include "access/multixact.h"
#include "access/rewriteheap.h"
#include "access/subtrans.h"
#include "access/timeline.h"
#include "access/transam.h"
#include "access/twophase.h"
#include "access/xact.h"
#include "access/xlog_internal.h"
#include "access/xlogarchive.h"
#include "access/xloginsert.h"
#include "access/xlogreader.h"
#include "access/xlogrecovery.h"
#include "access/xlogutils.h"
#include "access/xlogwait.h"
#include "backup/basebackup.h"
#include "catalog/catversion.h"
#include "catalog/pg_control.h"
#include "catalog/pg_database.h"
#include "common/controldata_utils.h"
#include "common/file_utils.h"
#include "executor/instrument.h"
#include "miscadmin.h"
#include "pg_trace.h"
#include "pgstat.h"
#include "port/atomics.h"
#include "postmaster/bgwriter.h"
#include "postmaster/startup.h"
#include "postmaster/walsummarizer.h"
#include "postmaster/walwriter.h"
#include "replication/origin.h"
#include "replication/slot.h"
#include "replication/snapbuild.h"
#include "replication/walreceiver.h"
#include "replication/walsender.h"
#include "storage/bufmgr.h"
#include "storage/fd.h"
#include "storage/ipc.h"
#include "storage/large_object.h"
#include "storage/latch.h"
#include "storage/predicate.h"
#include "storage/proc.h"
#include "storage/procarray.h"
#include "storage/reinit.h"
#include "storage/spin.h"
#include "storage/sync.h"
#include "utils/guc_hooks.h"
#include "utils/guc_tables.h"
#include "utils/injection_point.h"
#include "utils/pgstat_internal.h"
#include "utils/ps_status.h"
#include "utils/relmapper.h"
#include "utils/snapmgr.h"
#include "utils/timeout.h"
#include "utils/timestamp.h"
#include "utils/varlena.h"
Include dependency graph for xlog.c:

Go to the source code of this file.

Data Structures

struct  XLogwrtRqst
 
struct  XLogwrtResult
 
struct  WALInsertLock
 
union  WALInsertLockPadded
 
struct  XLogCtlInsert
 
struct  XLogCtlData
 

Macros

#define BootstrapTimeLineID   1
 
#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS   8
 
#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)    (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))
 
#define NextBufIdx(idx)    (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))
 
#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)    (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))
 
#define UsableBytesInPage   (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)
 
#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)   XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))
 
#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target)
 

Typedefs

typedef struct XLogwrtRqst XLogwrtRqst
 
typedef struct XLogwrtResult XLogwrtResult
 
typedef union WALInsertLockPadded WALInsertLockPadded
 
typedef struct XLogCtlInsert XLogCtlInsert
 
typedef struct XLogCtlData XLogCtlData
 

Enumerations

enum  WalInsertClass { WALINSERT_NORMAL , WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH , WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT }
 

Functions

static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery (TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
 
static void CheckRequiredParameterValues (void)
 
static void XLogReportParameters (void)
 
static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed (void)
 
static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord (void)
 
static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord (XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr, TimeLineID newTLI)
 
static void CheckPointGuts (XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
 
static void KeepLogSeg (XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
 
static XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN (void)
 
static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer (XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
 
static void XLogWrite (XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
 
static bool InstallXLogFileSegment (XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
 
static void XLogFileClose (void)
 
static void PreallocXlogFiles (XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
 
static void RemoveTempXlogFiles (void)
 
static void RemoveOldXlogFiles (XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI)
 
static void RemoveXlogFile (const struct dirent *segment_de, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo, TimeLineID insertTLI)
 
static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr (char *filename)
 
static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure (void)
 
static void CleanupBackupHistory (void)
 
static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint (XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
 
static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction (void)
 
static void InitControlFile (uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
 
static void WriteControlFile (void)
 
static void ReadControlFile (void)
 
static void UpdateControlFile (void)
 
static char * str_time (pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
 
static int get_sync_bit (int method)
 
static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL (int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
 
static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation (int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
 
static bool ReserveXLogSwitch (XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
 
static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish (XLogRecPtr upto)
 
static char * GetXLogBuffer (XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
 
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr (uint64 bytepos)
 
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr (uint64 bytepos)
 
static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos (XLogRecPtr ptr)
 
static void WALInsertLockAcquire (void)
 
static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive (void)
 
static void WALInsertLockRelease (void)
 
static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt (XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
 
XLogRecPtr XLogInsertRecord (XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr fpw_lsn, uint8 flags, int num_fpi, uint64 fpi_bytes, bool topxid_included)
 
Size WALReadFromBuffers (char *dstbuf, XLogRecPtr startptr, Size count, TimeLineID tli)
 
static void CalculateCheckpointSegments (void)
 
void assign_max_wal_size (int newval, void *extra)
 
void assign_checkpoint_completion_target (double newval, void *extra)
 
bool check_wal_segment_size (int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
 
static XLogSegNo XLOGfileslop (XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
 
bool XLogCheckpointNeeded (XLogSegNo new_segno)
 
void XLogSetAsyncXactLSN (XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN)
 
void XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN (XLogRecPtr lsn)
 
void XLogFlush (XLogRecPtr record)
 
bool XLogBackgroundFlush (void)
 
bool XLogNeedsFlush (XLogRecPtr record)
 
static int XLogFileInitInternal (XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli, bool *added, char *path)
 
int XLogFileInit (XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
 
static void XLogFileCopy (TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno, int upto)
 
int XLogFileOpen (XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
 
void CheckXLogRemoved (XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
 
XLogSegNo XLogGetLastRemovedSegno (void)
 
XLogSegNo XLogGetOldestSegno (TimeLineID tli)
 
void RemoveNonParentXlogFiles (XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
 
uint64 GetSystemIdentifier (void)
 
char * GetMockAuthenticationNonce (void)
 
bool DataChecksumsEnabled (void)
 
bool GetDefaultCharSignedness (void)
 
XLogRecPtr GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel (void)
 
static int XLOGChooseNumBuffers (void)
 
bool check_wal_buffers (int *newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
 
bool check_wal_consistency_checking (char **newval, void **extra, GucSource source)
 
void assign_wal_consistency_checking (const char *newval, void *extra)
 
void InitializeWalConsistencyChecking (void)
 
const char * show_archive_command (void)
 
const char * show_in_hot_standby (void)
 
void LocalProcessControlFile (bool reset)
 
WalLevel GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby (void)
 
Size XLOGShmemSize (void)
 
void XLOGShmemInit (void)
 
void BootStrapXLOG (uint32 data_checksum_version)
 
static void XLogInitNewTimeline (TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
 
void StartupXLOG (void)
 
void SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery (XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID replayTLI)
 
void ReachedEndOfBackup (XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr, TimeLineID tli)
 
bool RecoveryInProgress (void)
 
RecoveryState GetRecoveryState (void)
 
bool XLogInsertAllowed (void)
 
XLogRecPtr GetRedoRecPtr (void)
 
void GetFullPageWriteInfo (XLogRecPtr *RedoRecPtr_p, bool *doPageWrites_p)
 
XLogRecPtr GetInsertRecPtr (void)
 
XLogRecPtr GetFlushRecPtr (TimeLineID *insertTLI)
 
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLine (void)
 
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet (void)
 
XLogRecPtr GetLastImportantRecPtr (void)
 
pg_time_t GetLastSegSwitchData (XLogRecPtr *lastSwitchLSN)
 
void ShutdownXLOG (int code, Datum arg)
 
static void LogCheckpointStart (int flags, bool restartpoint)
 
static void LogCheckpointEnd (bool restartpoint)
 
static void UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate (uint64 nbytes)
 
static void update_checkpoint_display (int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
 
bool CreateCheckPoint (int flags)
 
static void RecoveryRestartPoint (const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
 
bool CreateRestartPoint (int flags)
 
WALAvailability GetWALAvailability (XLogRecPtr targetLSN)
 
void XLogPutNextOid (Oid nextOid)
 
XLogRecPtr RequestXLogSwitch (bool mark_unimportant)
 
XLogRecPtr XLogRestorePoint (const char *rpName)
 
void UpdateFullPageWrites (void)
 
void xlog_redo (XLogReaderState *record)
 
void assign_wal_sync_method (int new_wal_sync_method, void *extra)
 
void issue_xlog_fsync (int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
 
void do_pg_backup_start (const char *backupidstr, bool fast, List **tablespaces, BackupState *state, StringInfo tblspcmapfile)
 
SessionBackupState get_backup_status (void)
 
void do_pg_backup_stop (BackupState *state, bool waitforarchive)
 
void do_pg_abort_backup (int code, Datum arg)
 
void register_persistent_abort_backup_handler (void)
 
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertRecPtr (void)
 
XLogRecPtr GetXLogWriteRecPtr (void)
 
void GetOldestRestartPoint (XLogRecPtr *oldrecptr, TimeLineID *oldtli)
 
void XLogShutdownWalRcv (void)
 
void SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive (void)
 
void ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive (void)
 
bool IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive (void)
 
void SetWalWriterSleeping (bool sleeping)
 

Variables

int max_wal_size_mb = 1024
 
int min_wal_size_mb = 80
 
int wal_keep_size_mb = 0
 
int XLOGbuffers = -1
 
int XLogArchiveTimeout = 0
 
int XLogArchiveMode = ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF
 
char * XLogArchiveCommand = NULL
 
bool EnableHotStandby = false
 
bool fullPageWrites = true
 
bool wal_log_hints = false
 
int wal_compression = WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE
 
char * wal_consistency_checking_string = NULL
 
bool * wal_consistency_checking = NULL
 
bool wal_init_zero = true
 
bool wal_recycle = true
 
bool log_checkpoints = true
 
int wal_sync_method = DEFAULT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD
 
int wal_level = WAL_LEVEL_REPLICA
 
int CommitDelay = 0
 
int CommitSiblings = 5
 
int wal_retrieve_retry_interval = 5000
 
int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb = -1
 
int wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024
 
bool track_wal_io_timing = false
 
int wal_segment_size = DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE
 
int CheckPointSegments
 
static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate = 0
 
static double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0
 
static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false
 
const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options []
 
const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options []
 
CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats
 
static bool lastFullPageWrites
 
static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true
 
static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1
 
XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr
 
XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr
 
XLogRecPtr XactLastCommitEnd = InvalidXLogRecPtr
 
static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
 
static bool doPageWrites
 
static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE
 
static XLogCtlDataXLogCtl = NULL
 
static WALInsertLockPaddedWALInsertLocks = NULL
 
static ControlFileDataControlFile = NULL
 
static int UsableBytesInSegment
 
static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult = {0, 0}
 
static int openLogFile = -1
 
static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo = 0
 
static TimeLineID openLogTLI = 0
 
static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint
 
static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI
 
static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true
 
static int MyLockNo = 0
 
static bool holdingAllLocks = false
 

Macro Definition Documentation

◆ BootstrapTimeLineID

#define BootstrapTimeLineID   1

Definition at line 113 of file xlog.c.

◆ ConvertToXSegs

#define ConvertToXSegs (   x,
  segsize 
)    XLogMBVarToSegs((x), (segsize))

Definition at line 604 of file xlog.c.

◆ INSERT_FREESPACE

#define INSERT_FREESPACE (   endptr)     (((endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ == 0) ? 0 : (XLOG_BLCKSZ - (endptr) % XLOG_BLCKSZ))

Definition at line 581 of file xlog.c.

◆ NextBufIdx

#define NextBufIdx (   idx)     (((idx) == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck) ? 0 : ((idx) + 1))

Definition at line 585 of file xlog.c.

◆ NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS

#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS   8

Definition at line 152 of file xlog.c.

◆ RefreshXLogWriteResult

#define RefreshXLogWriteResult (   _target)
Value:
do { \
pg_read_barrier(); \
} while (0)
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition: atomics.h:467
pg_atomic_uint64 logWriteResult
Definition: xlog.c:473
pg_atomic_uint64 logFlushResult
Definition: xlog.c:474
static XLogCtlData * XLogCtl
Definition: xlog.c:567

Definition at line 621 of file xlog.c.

◆ UsableBytesInPage

#define UsableBytesInPage   (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogShortPHD)

Definition at line 598 of file xlog.c.

◆ XLogRecPtrToBufIdx

#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx (   recptr)     (((recptr) / XLOG_BLCKSZ) % (XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck + 1))

Definition at line 592 of file xlog.c.

Typedef Documentation

◆ WALInsertLockPadded

◆ XLogCtlData

typedef struct XLogCtlData XLogCtlData

◆ XLogCtlInsert

typedef struct XLogCtlInsert XLogCtlInsert

◆ XLogwrtResult

typedef struct XLogwrtResult XLogwrtResult

◆ XLogwrtRqst

typedef struct XLogwrtRqst XLogwrtRqst

Enumeration Type Documentation

◆ WalInsertClass

Enumerator
WALINSERT_NORMAL 
WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH 
WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT 

Definition at line 560 of file xlog.c.

561{
WalInsertClass
Definition: xlog.c:561
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH
Definition: xlog.c:563
@ WALINSERT_NORMAL
Definition: xlog.c:562
@ WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT
Definition: xlog.c:564

Function Documentation

◆ AdvanceXLInsertBuffer()

static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer ( XLogRecPtr  upto,
TimeLineID  tli,
bool  opportunistic 
)
static

Definition at line 1991 of file xlog.c.

1992{
1994 int nextidx;
1995 XLogRecPtr OldPageRqstPtr;
1996 XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
1997 XLogRecPtr NewPageEndPtr = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
1998 XLogRecPtr NewPageBeginPtr;
1999 XLogPageHeader NewPage;
2000 int npages pg_attribute_unused() = 0;
2001
2002 LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
2003
2004 /*
2005 * Now that we have the lock, check if someone initialized the page
2006 * already.
2007 */
2008 while (upto >= XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo || opportunistic)
2009 {
2011
2012 /*
2013 * Get ending-offset of the buffer page we need to replace (this may
2014 * be zero if the buffer hasn't been used yet). Fall through if it's
2015 * already written out.
2016 */
2017 OldPageRqstPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx]);
2018 if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
2019 {
2020 /*
2021 * Nope, got work to do. If we just want to pre-initialize as much
2022 * as we can without flushing, give up now.
2023 */
2024 if (opportunistic)
2025 break;
2026
2027 /* Advance shared memory write request position */
2029 if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
2030 XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
2032
2033 /*
2034 * Acquire an up-to-date LogwrtResult value and see if we still
2035 * need to write it or if someone else already did.
2036 */
2038 if (LogwrtResult.Write < OldPageRqstPtr)
2039 {
2040 /*
2041 * Must acquire write lock. Release WALBufMappingLock first,
2042 * to make sure that all insertions that we need to wait for
2043 * can finish (up to this same position). Otherwise we risk
2044 * deadlock.
2045 */
2046 LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
2047
2048 WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(OldPageRqstPtr);
2049
2050 LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
2051
2053 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= OldPageRqstPtr)
2054 {
2055 /* OK, someone wrote it already */
2056 LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
2057 }
2058 else
2059 {
2060 /* Have to write it ourselves */
2061 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_START();
2062 WriteRqst.Write = OldPageRqstPtr;
2063 WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
2064 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, tli, false);
2065 LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
2067 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_BUFFER_WRITE_DIRTY_DONE();
2068
2069 /*
2070 * Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data, per
2071 * update of pgWalUsage.
2072 */
2073 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
2074 }
2075 /* Re-acquire WALBufMappingLock and retry */
2076 LWLockAcquire(WALBufMappingLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
2077 continue;
2078 }
2079 }
2080
2081 /*
2082 * Now the next buffer slot is free and we can set it up to be the
2083 * next output page.
2084 */
2085 NewPageBeginPtr = XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo;
2086 NewPageEndPtr = NewPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2087
2088 Assert(XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(NewPageBeginPtr) == nextidx);
2089
2090 NewPage = (XLogPageHeader) (XLogCtl->pages + nextidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ);
2091
2092 /*
2093 * Mark the xlblock with InvalidXLogRecPtr and issue a write barrier
2094 * before initializing. Otherwise, the old page may be partially
2095 * zeroed but look valid.
2096 */
2099
2100 /*
2101 * Be sure to re-zero the buffer so that bytes beyond what we've
2102 * written will look like zeroes and not valid XLOG records...
2103 */
2104 MemSet(NewPage, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ);
2105
2106 /*
2107 * Fill the new page's header
2108 */
2109 NewPage->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
2110
2111 /* NewPage->xlp_info = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2112 NewPage->xlp_tli = tli;
2113 NewPage->xlp_pageaddr = NewPageBeginPtr;
2114
2115 /* NewPage->xlp_rem_len = 0; */ /* done by memset */
2116
2117 /*
2118 * If online backup is not in progress, mark the header to indicate
2119 * that WAL records beginning in this page have removable backup
2120 * blocks. This allows the WAL archiver to know whether it is safe to
2121 * compress archived WAL data by transforming full-block records into
2122 * the non-full-block format. It is sufficient to record this at the
2123 * page level because we force a page switch (in fact a segment
2124 * switch) when starting a backup, so the flag will be off before any
2125 * records can be written during the backup. At the end of a backup,
2126 * the last page will be marked as all unsafe when perhaps only part
2127 * is unsafe, but at worst the archiver would miss the opportunity to
2128 * compress a few records.
2129 */
2130 if (Insert->runningBackups == 0)
2131 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE;
2132
2133 /*
2134 * If first page of an XLOG segment file, make it a long header.
2135 */
2136 if ((XLogSegmentOffset(NewPage->xlp_pageaddr, wal_segment_size)) == 0)
2137 {
2138 XLogLongPageHeader NewLongPage = (XLogLongPageHeader) NewPage;
2139
2140 NewLongPage->xlp_sysid = ControlFile->system_identifier;
2141 NewLongPage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
2142 NewLongPage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2143 NewPage->xlp_info |= XLP_LONG_HEADER;
2144 }
2145
2146 /*
2147 * Make sure the initialization of the page becomes visible to others
2148 * before the xlblocks update. GetXLogBuffer() reads xlblocks without
2149 * holding a lock.
2150 */
2152
2153 pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[nextidx], NewPageEndPtr);
2154 XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = NewPageEndPtr;
2155
2156 npages++;
2157 }
2158 LWLockRelease(WALBufMappingLock);
2159
2160#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2161 if (XLOG_DEBUG && npages > 0)
2162 {
2163 elog(DEBUG1, "initialized %d pages, up to %X/%08X",
2164 npages, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(NewPageEndPtr));
2165 }
2166#endif
2167}
static void pg_atomic_write_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition: atomics.h:485
#define pg_write_barrier()
Definition: atomics.h:155
#define pg_attribute_unused()
Definition: c.h:138
#define MemSet(start, val, len)
Definition: c.h:1032
size_t Size
Definition: c.h:624
#define DEBUG1
Definition: elog.h:30
#define elog(elevel,...)
Definition: elog.h:226
static void Insert(File file)
Definition: fd.c:1297
Assert(PointerIsAligned(start, uint64))
WalUsage pgWalUsage
Definition: instrument.c:22
bool LWLockAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition: lwlock.c:1174
void LWLockRelease(LWLock *lock)
Definition: lwlock.c:1894
@ LW_EXCLUSIVE
Definition: lwlock.h:112
bool pgstat_report_fixed
Definition: pgstat.c:218
#define SpinLockRelease(lock)
Definition: spin.h:61
#define SpinLockAcquire(lock)
Definition: spin.h:59
uint64 system_identifier
Definition: pg_control.h:110
int64 wal_buffers_full
Definition: instrument.h:57
XLogwrtRqst LogwrtRqst
Definition: xlog.c:457
slock_t info_lck
Definition: xlog.c:554
XLogRecPtr InitializedUpTo
Definition: xlog.c:486
char * pages
Definition: xlog.c:493
pg_atomic_uint64 * xlblocks
Definition: xlog.c:494
XLogCtlInsert Insert
Definition: xlog.c:454
TimeLineID xlp_tli
Definition: xlog_internal.h:40
XLogRecPtr xlp_pageaddr
Definition: xlog_internal.h:41
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition: xlog.c:329
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition: xlog.c:324
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition: xlog.c:323
static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(XLogRecPtr upto)
Definition: xlog.c:1510
#define RefreshXLogWriteResult(_target)
Definition: xlog.c:621
int wal_segment_size
Definition: xlog.c:145
static XLogwrtResult LogwrtResult
Definition: xlog.c:613
#define XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr)
Definition: xlog.c:592
static void XLogWrite(XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst, TimeLineID tli, bool flexible)
Definition: xlog.c:2307
static ControlFileData * ControlFile
Definition: xlog.c:575
XLogLongPageHeaderData * XLogLongPageHeader
Definition: xlog_internal.h:71
#define XLogSegmentOffset(xlogptr, wal_segsz_bytes)
XLogPageHeaderData * XLogPageHeader
Definition: xlog_internal.h:54
#define XLP_LONG_HEADER
Definition: xlog_internal.h:76
#define XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE
Definition: xlog_internal.h:78
#define XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC
Definition: xlog_internal.h:34
#define LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn)
Definition: xlogdefs.h:47
uint64 XLogRecPtr
Definition: xlogdefs.h:21
#define InvalidXLogRecPtr
Definition: xlogdefs.h:28

References Assert(), ControlFile, DEBUG1, elog, XLogwrtRqst::Flush, XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::InitializedUpTo, XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), InvalidXLogRecPtr, LogwrtResult, XLogCtlData::LogwrtRqst, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), MemSet, XLogCtlData::pages, pg_atomic_read_u64(), pg_atomic_write_u64(), pg_attribute_unused, pg_write_barrier, pgstat_report_fixed, pgWalUsage, RefreshXLogWriteResult, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, ControlFileData::system_identifier, WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(), WalUsage::wal_buffers_full, wal_segment_size, XLogwrtRqst::Write, XLogwrtResult::Write, XLogCtlData::xlblocks, XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC, XLogCtl, XLogRecPtrToBufIdx, XLogSegmentOffset, XLogWrite(), XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_info, XLP_LONG_HEADER, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_magic, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_pageaddr, XLogLongPageHeaderData::xlp_seg_size, XLogLongPageHeaderData::xlp_sysid, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_tli, and XLogLongPageHeaderData::xlp_xlog_blcksz.

Referenced by GetXLogBuffer(), and XLogBackgroundFlush().

◆ assign_checkpoint_completion_target()

void assign_checkpoint_completion_target ( double  newval,
void *  extra 
)

Definition at line 2210 of file xlog.c.

2211{
2214}
double CheckPointCompletionTarget
Definition: checkpointer.c:159
#define newval
static void CalculateCheckpointSegments(void)
Definition: xlog.c:2174

References CalculateCheckpointSegments(), CheckPointCompletionTarget, and newval.

◆ assign_max_wal_size()

void assign_max_wal_size ( int  newval,
void *  extra 
)

Definition at line 2203 of file xlog.c.

2204{
2207}
int max_wal_size_mb
Definition: xlog.c:116

References CalculateCheckpointSegments(), max_wal_size_mb, and newval.

◆ assign_wal_consistency_checking()

void assign_wal_consistency_checking ( const char *  newval,
void *  extra 
)

Definition at line 4815 of file xlog.c.

4816{
4817 /*
4818 * If some checks were deferred, it's possible that the checks will fail
4819 * later during InitializeWalConsistencyChecking(). But in that case, the
4820 * postmaster will exit anyway, so it's safe to proceed with the
4821 * assignment.
4822 *
4823 * Any built-in resource managers specified are assigned immediately,
4824 * which affects WAL created before shared_preload_libraries are
4825 * processed. Any custom resource managers specified won't be assigned
4826 * until after shared_preload_libraries are processed, but that's OK
4827 * because WAL for a custom resource manager can't be written before the
4828 * module is loaded anyway.
4829 */
4831}
bool * wal_consistency_checking
Definition: xlog.c:128

References wal_consistency_checking.

◆ assign_wal_sync_method()

void assign_wal_sync_method ( int  new_wal_sync_method,
void *  extra 
)

Definition at line 8715 of file xlog.c.

8716{
8717 if (wal_sync_method != new_wal_sync_method)
8718 {
8719 /*
8720 * To ensure that no blocks escape unsynced, force an fsync on the
8721 * currently open log segment (if any). Also, if the open flag is
8722 * changing, close the log file so it will be reopened (with new flag
8723 * bit) at next use.
8724 */
8725 if (openLogFile >= 0)
8726 {
8727 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC_METHOD_ASSIGN);
8728 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
8729 {
8730 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8731 int save_errno;
8732
8733 save_errno = errno;
8736 errno = save_errno;
8737 ereport(PANIC,
8739 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
8740 }
8741
8743 if (get_sync_bit(wal_sync_method) != get_sync_bit(new_wal_sync_method))
8744 XLogFileClose();
8745 }
8746 }
8747}
int errcode_for_file_access(void)
Definition: elog.c:886
int errmsg(const char *fmt,...)
Definition: elog.c:1080
#define PANIC
Definition: elog.h:42
#define ereport(elevel,...)
Definition: elog.h:150
int pg_fsync(int fd)
Definition: fd.c:386
static void pgstat_report_wait_start(uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition: wait_event.h:69
static void pgstat_report_wait_end(void)
Definition: wait_event.h:85
static int openLogFile
Definition: xlog.c:636
static int get_sync_bit(int method)
Definition: xlog.c:8667
int wal_sync_method
Definition: xlog.c:132
static TimeLineID openLogTLI
Definition: xlog.c:638
static void XLogFileClose(void)
Definition: xlog.c:3660
static XLogSegNo openLogSegNo
Definition: xlog.c:637
#define MAXFNAMELEN
static void XLogFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)

References ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), get_sync_bit(), MAXFNAMELEN, openLogFile, openLogSegNo, openLogTLI, PANIC, pg_fsync(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), wal_segment_size, wal_sync_method, XLogFileClose(), and XLogFileName().

◆ BootStrapXLOG()

void BootStrapXLOG ( uint32  data_checksum_version)

Definition at line 5091 of file xlog.c.

5092{
5093 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5094 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
5095 XLogPageHeader page;
5096 XLogLongPageHeader longpage;
5097 XLogRecord *record;
5098 char *recptr;
5099 uint64 sysidentifier;
5100 struct timeval tv;
5101 pg_crc32c crc;
5102
5103 /* allow ordinary WAL segment creation, like StartupXLOG() would */
5105
5106 /*
5107 * Select a hopefully-unique system identifier code for this installation.
5108 * We use the result of gettimeofday(), including the fractional seconds
5109 * field, as being about as unique as we can easily get. (Think not to
5110 * use random(), since it hasn't been seeded and there's no portable way
5111 * to seed it other than the system clock value...) The upper half of the
5112 * uint64 value is just the tv_sec part, while the lower half contains the
5113 * tv_usec part (which must fit in 20 bits), plus 12 bits from our current
5114 * PID for a little extra uniqueness. A person knowing this encoding can
5115 * determine the initialization time of the installation, which could
5116 * perhaps be useful sometimes.
5117 */
5118 gettimeofday(&tv, NULL);
5119 sysidentifier = ((uint64) tv.tv_sec) << 32;
5120 sysidentifier |= ((uint64) tv.tv_usec) << 12;
5121 sysidentifier |= getpid() & 0xFFF;
5122
5123 memset(&buffer, 0, sizeof buffer);
5124 page = (XLogPageHeader) &buffer;
5125
5126 /*
5127 * Set up information for the initial checkpoint record
5128 *
5129 * The initial checkpoint record is written to the beginning of the WAL
5130 * segment with logid=0 logseg=1. The very first WAL segment, 0/0, is not
5131 * used, so that we can use 0/0 to mean "before any valid WAL segment".
5132 */
5136 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = fullPageWrites;
5137 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
5138 checkPoint.nextXid =
5140 checkPoint.nextOid = FirstGenbkiObjectId;
5141 checkPoint.nextMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5142 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset = 1;
5144 checkPoint.oldestXidDB = Template1DbOid;
5145 checkPoint.oldestMulti = FirstMultiXactId;
5146 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB = Template1DbOid;
5149 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
5151
5152 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5153 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5155 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5156 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5157 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5158 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5160
5161 /* Set up the XLOG page header */
5162 page->xlp_magic = XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC;
5163 page->xlp_info = XLP_LONG_HEADER;
5166 longpage = (XLogLongPageHeader) page;
5167 longpage->xlp_sysid = sysidentifier;
5168 longpage->xlp_seg_size = wal_segment_size;
5169 longpage->xlp_xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
5170
5171 /* Insert the initial checkpoint record */
5172 recptr = ((char *) page + SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
5173 record = (XLogRecord *) recptr;
5174 record->xl_prev = 0;
5175 record->xl_xid = InvalidTransactionId;
5176 record->xl_tot_len = SizeOfXLogRecord + SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort + sizeof(checkPoint);
5178 record->xl_rmid = RM_XLOG_ID;
5179 recptr += SizeOfXLogRecord;
5180 /* fill the XLogRecordDataHeaderShort struct */
5181 *(recptr++) = (char) XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT;
5182 *(recptr++) = sizeof(checkPoint);
5183 memcpy(recptr, &checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
5184 recptr += sizeof(checkPoint);
5185 Assert(recptr - (char *) record == record->xl_tot_len);
5186
5188 COMP_CRC32C(crc, ((char *) record) + SizeOfXLogRecord, record->xl_tot_len - SizeOfXLogRecord);
5189 COMP_CRC32C(crc, (char *) record, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
5190 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
5191 record->xl_crc = crc;
5192
5193 /* Create first XLOG segment file */
5196
5197 /*
5198 * We needn't bother with Reserve/ReleaseExternalFD here, since we'll
5199 * close the file again in a moment.
5200 */
5201
5202 /* Write the first page with the initial record */
5203 errno = 0;
5204 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_WRITE);
5205 if (write(openLogFile, &buffer, XLOG_BLCKSZ) != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
5206 {
5207 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
5208 if (errno == 0)
5209 errno = ENOSPC;
5210 ereport(PANIC,
5212 errmsg("could not write bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5213 }
5215
5216 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_BOOTSTRAP_SYNC);
5217 if (pg_fsync(openLogFile) != 0)
5218 ereport(PANIC,
5220 errmsg("could not fsync bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5222
5223 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
5224 ereport(PANIC,
5226 errmsg("could not close bootstrap write-ahead log file: %m")));
5227
5228 openLogFile = -1;
5229
5230 /* Now create pg_control */
5231 InitControlFile(sysidentifier, data_checksum_version);
5232 ControlFile->time = checkPoint.time;
5233 ControlFile->checkPoint = checkPoint.redo;
5234 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
5235
5236 /* some additional ControlFile fields are set in WriteControlFile() */
5238
5239 /* Bootstrap the commit log, too */
5240 BootStrapCLOG();
5244
5245 /*
5246 * Force control file to be read - in contrast to normal processing we'd
5247 * otherwise never run the checks and GUC related initializations therein.
5248 */
5250}
uint64_t uint64
Definition: c.h:553
void BootStrapCLOG(void)
Definition: clog.c:832
void BootStrapCommitTs(void)
Definition: commit_ts.c:594
void SetCommitTsLimit(TransactionId oldestXact, TransactionId newestXact)
Definition: commit_ts.c:887
#define close(a)
Definition: win32.h:12
#define write(a, b, c)
Definition: win32.h:14
void MultiXactSetNextMXact(MultiXactId nextMulti, MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset)
Definition: multixact.c:1989
void BootStrapMultiXact(void)
Definition: multixact.c:1790
void SetMultiXactIdLimit(MultiXactId oldest_datminmxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition: multixact.c:2011
#define FirstMultiXactId
Definition: multixact.h:26
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN
Definition: pg_control.h:68
uint32 pg_crc32c
Definition: pg_crc32c.h:38
#define COMP_CRC32C(crc, data, len)
Definition: pg_crc32c.h:153
#define INIT_CRC32C(crc)
Definition: pg_crc32c.h:41
#define FIN_CRC32C(crc)
Definition: pg_crc32c.h:158
return crc
int64 pg_time_t
Definition: pgtime.h:23
Oid oldestMultiDB
Definition: pg_control.h:51
MultiXactId oldestMulti
Definition: pg_control.h:50
MultiXactOffset nextMultiOffset
Definition: pg_control.h:47
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition: pg_control.h:55
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition: pg_control.h:48
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition: pg_control.h:40
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID
Definition: pg_control.h:39
Oid nextOid
Definition: pg_control.h:45
TransactionId oldestActiveXid
Definition: pg_control.h:64
bool fullPageWrites
Definition: pg_control.h:42
MultiXactId nextMulti
Definition: pg_control.h:46
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition: pg_control.h:44
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition: pg_control.h:53
pg_time_t time
Definition: pg_control.h:52
int wal_level
Definition: pg_control.h:43
XLogRecPtr redo
Definition: pg_control.h:37
Oid oldestXidDB
Definition: pg_control.h:49
CheckPoint checkPointCopy
Definition: pg_control.h:135
pg_time_t time
Definition: pg_control.h:132
XLogRecPtr checkPoint
Definition: pg_control.h:133
FullTransactionId nextXid
Definition: transam.h:220
XLogRecPtr xl_prev
Definition: xlogrecord.h:45
uint8 xl_info
Definition: xlogrecord.h:46
uint32 xl_tot_len
Definition: xlogrecord.h:43
TransactionId xl_xid
Definition: xlogrecord.h:44
RmgrId xl_rmid
Definition: xlogrecord.h:47
void BootStrapSUBTRANS(void)
Definition: subtrans.c:269
#define InvalidTransactionId
Definition: transam.h:31
#define FirstGenbkiObjectId
Definition: transam.h:195
#define FirstNormalTransactionId
Definition: transam.h:34
static FullTransactionId FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(uint32 epoch, TransactionId xid)
Definition: transam.h:71
void SetTransactionIdLimit(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid, Oid oldest_datoid)
Definition: varsup.c:372
void AdvanceOldestClogXid(TransactionId oldest_datfrozenxid)
Definition: varsup.c:355
TransamVariablesData * TransamVariables
Definition: varsup.c:34
int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tp, void *tzp)
int XLogFileInit(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli)
Definition: xlog.c:3401
bool fullPageWrites
Definition: xlog.c:124
static void InitControlFile(uint64 sysidentifier, uint32 data_checksum_version)
Definition: xlog.c:4225
void SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition: xlog.c:9545
int wal_level
Definition: xlog.c:133
static void WriteControlFile(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4260
#define BootstrapTimeLineID
Definition: xlog.c:113
static void ReadControlFile(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4370
#define SizeOfXLogLongPHD
Definition: xlog_internal.h:69
#define SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort
Definition: xlogrecord.h:217
#define XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT
Definition: xlogrecord.h:241
#define SizeOfXLogRecord
Definition: xlogrecord.h:55

References AdvanceOldestClogXid(), Assert(), BootStrapCLOG(), BootStrapCommitTs(), BootStrapMultiXact(), BootStrapSUBTRANS(), BootstrapTimeLineID, ControlFileData::checkPoint, ControlFileData::checkPointCopy, close, COMP_CRC32C, ControlFile, crc, ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), FIN_CRC32C, FirstGenbkiObjectId, FirstMultiXactId, FirstNormalTransactionId, fullPageWrites, CheckPoint::fullPageWrites, FullTransactionIdFromEpochAndXid(), gettimeofday(), INIT_CRC32C, InitControlFile(), InvalidTransactionId, MultiXactSetNextMXact(), CheckPoint::newestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::nextMulti, CheckPoint::nextMultiOffset, TransamVariablesData::nextOid, CheckPoint::nextOid, TransamVariablesData::nextXid, CheckPoint::nextXid, TransamVariablesData::oidCount, CheckPoint::oldestActiveXid, CheckPoint::oldestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::oldestMulti, CheckPoint::oldestMultiDB, CheckPoint::oldestXid, CheckPoint::oldestXidDB, openLogFile, openLogTLI, PANIC, pg_fsync(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), CheckPoint::PrevTimeLineID, ReadControlFile(), CheckPoint::redo, SetCommitTsLimit(), SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(), SetMultiXactIdLimit(), SetTransactionIdLimit(), SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogRecord, SizeOfXLogRecordDataHeaderShort, CheckPoint::ThisTimeLineID, CheckPoint::time, ControlFileData::time, TransamVariables, wal_level, CheckPoint::wal_level, wal_segment_size, write, WriteControlFile(), XLogRecord::xl_crc, XLogRecord::xl_info, XLogRecord::xl_prev, XLogRecord::xl_rmid, XLogRecord::xl_tot_len, XLogRecord::xl_xid, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN, XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC, XLogFileInit(), XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_info, XLP_LONG_HEADER, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_magic, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_pageaddr, XLogLongPageHeaderData::xlp_seg_size, XLogLongPageHeaderData::xlp_sysid, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_tli, XLogLongPageHeaderData::xlp_xlog_blcksz, and XLR_BLOCK_ID_DATA_SHORT.

Referenced by BootstrapModeMain().

◆ CalculateCheckpointSegments()

static void CalculateCheckpointSegments ( void  )
static

Definition at line 2174 of file xlog.c.

2175{
2176 double target;
2177
2178 /*-------
2179 * Calculate the distance at which to trigger a checkpoint, to avoid
2180 * exceeding max_wal_size_mb. This is based on two assumptions:
2181 *
2182 * a) we keep WAL for only one checkpoint cycle (prior to PG11 we kept
2183 * WAL for two checkpoint cycles to allow us to recover from the
2184 * secondary checkpoint if the first checkpoint failed, though we
2185 * only did this on the primary anyway, not on standby. Keeping just
2186 * one checkpoint simplifies processing and reduces disk space in
2187 * many smaller databases.)
2188 * b) during checkpoint, we consume checkpoint_completion_target *
2189 * number of segments consumed between checkpoints.
2190 *-------
2191 */
2192 target = (double) ConvertToXSegs(max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size) /
2194
2195 /* round down */
2196 CheckPointSegments = (int) target;
2197
2198 if (CheckPointSegments < 1)
2200}
#define ConvertToXSegs(x, segsize)
Definition: xlog.c:604
int CheckPointSegments
Definition: xlog.c:158

References CheckPointCompletionTarget, CheckPointSegments, ConvertToXSegs, max_wal_size_mb, and wal_segment_size.

Referenced by assign_checkpoint_completion_target(), assign_max_wal_size(), and ReadControlFile().

◆ check_wal_buffers()

bool check_wal_buffers ( int *  newval,
void **  extra,
GucSource  source 
)

Definition at line 4693 of file xlog.c.

4694{
4695 /*
4696 * -1 indicates a request for auto-tune.
4697 */
4698 if (*newval == -1)
4699 {
4700 /*
4701 * If we haven't yet changed the boot_val default of -1, just let it
4702 * be. We'll fix it when XLOGShmemSize is called.
4703 */
4704 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4705 return true;
4706
4707 /* Otherwise, substitute the auto-tune value */
4709 }
4710
4711 /*
4712 * We clamp manually-set values to at least 4 blocks. Prior to PostgreSQL
4713 * 9.1, a minimum of 4 was enforced by guc.c, but since that is no longer
4714 * the case, we just silently treat such values as a request for the
4715 * minimum. (We could throw an error instead, but that doesn't seem very
4716 * helpful.)
4717 */
4718 if (*newval < 4)
4719 *newval = 4;
4720
4721 return true;
4722}
static int XLOGChooseNumBuffers(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4677
int XLOGbuffers
Definition: xlog.c:119

References newval, XLOGbuffers, and XLOGChooseNumBuffers().

◆ check_wal_consistency_checking()

bool check_wal_consistency_checking ( char **  newval,
void **  extra,
GucSource  source 
)

Definition at line 4728 of file xlog.c.

4729{
4730 char *rawstring;
4731 List *elemlist;
4732 ListCell *l;
4733 bool newwalconsistency[RM_MAX_ID + 1];
4734
4735 /* Initialize the array */
4736 MemSet(newwalconsistency, 0, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4737
4738 /* Need a modifiable copy of string */
4739 rawstring = pstrdup(*newval);
4740
4741 /* Parse string into list of identifiers */
4742 if (!SplitIdentifierString(rawstring, ',', &elemlist))
4743 {
4744 /* syntax error in list */
4745 GUC_check_errdetail("List syntax is invalid.");
4746 pfree(rawstring);
4747 list_free(elemlist);
4748 return false;
4749 }
4750
4751 foreach(l, elemlist)
4752 {
4753 char *tok = (char *) lfirst(l);
4754 int rmid;
4755
4756 /* Check for 'all'. */
4757 if (pg_strcasecmp(tok, "all") == 0)
4758 {
4759 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4760 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL)
4761 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4762 }
4763 else
4764 {
4765 /* Check if the token matches any known resource manager. */
4766 bool found = false;
4767
4768 for (rmid = 0; rmid <= RM_MAX_ID; rmid++)
4769 {
4770 if (RmgrIdExists(rmid) && GetRmgr(rmid).rm_mask != NULL &&
4771 pg_strcasecmp(tok, GetRmgr(rmid).rm_name) == 0)
4772 {
4773 newwalconsistency[rmid] = true;
4774 found = true;
4775 break;
4776 }
4777 }
4778 if (!found)
4779 {
4780 /*
4781 * During startup, it might be a not-yet-loaded custom
4782 * resource manager. Defer checking until
4783 * InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().
4784 */
4786 {
4788 }
4789 else
4790 {
4791 GUC_check_errdetail("Unrecognized key word: \"%s\".", tok);
4792 pfree(rawstring);
4793 list_free(elemlist);
4794 return false;
4795 }
4796 }
4797 }
4798 }
4799
4800 pfree(rawstring);
4801 list_free(elemlist);
4802
4803 /* assign new value */
4804 *extra = guc_malloc(LOG, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4805 if (!*extra)
4806 return false;
4807 memcpy(*extra, newwalconsistency, (RM_MAX_ID + 1) * sizeof(bool));
4808 return true;
4809}
#define LOG
Definition: elog.h:31
void * guc_malloc(int elevel, size_t size)
Definition: guc.c:636
#define GUC_check_errdetail
Definition: guc.h:505
void list_free(List *list)
Definition: list.c:1546
char * pstrdup(const char *in)
Definition: mcxt.c:1759
void pfree(void *pointer)
Definition: mcxt.c:1594
bool process_shared_preload_libraries_done
Definition: miscinit.c:1787
#define lfirst(lc)
Definition: pg_list.h:172
int pg_strcasecmp(const char *s1, const char *s2)
Definition: pgstrcasecmp.c:32
#define RM_MAX_ID
Definition: rmgr.h:33
Definition: pg_list.h:54
void(* rm_mask)(char *pagedata, BlockNumber blkno)
bool SplitIdentifierString(char *rawstring, char separator, List **namelist)
Definition: varlena.c:2755
static bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred
Definition: xlog.c:168
static RmgrData GetRmgr(RmgrId rmid)
static bool RmgrIdExists(RmgrId rmid)

References check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred, GetRmgr(), GUC_check_errdetail, guc_malloc(), lfirst, list_free(), LOG, MemSet, newval, pfree(), pg_strcasecmp(), process_shared_preload_libraries_done, pstrdup(), RmgrData::rm_mask, RM_MAX_ID, RmgrIdExists(), and SplitIdentifierString().

◆ check_wal_segment_size()

bool check_wal_segment_size ( int *  newval,
void **  extra,
GucSource  source 
)

Definition at line 2217 of file xlog.c.

2218{
2220 {
2221 GUC_check_errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.");
2222 return false;
2223 }
2224
2225 return true;
2226}
#define IsValidWalSegSize(size)
Definition: xlog_internal.h:96

References GUC_check_errdetail, IsValidWalSegSize, and newval.

◆ CheckPointGuts()

static void CheckPointGuts ( XLogRecPtr  checkPointRedo,
int  flags 
)
static

Definition at line 7577 of file xlog.c.

7578{
7584
7585 /* Write out all dirty data in SLRUs and the main buffer pool */
7586 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
7593 CheckPointBuffers(flags);
7594
7595 /* Perform all queued up fsyncs */
7596 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_SYNC_START();
7600 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_BUFFER_CHECKPOINT_DONE();
7601
7602 /* We deliberately delay 2PC checkpointing as long as possible */
7603 CheckPointTwoPhase(checkPointRedo);
7604}
TimestampTz GetCurrentTimestamp(void)
Definition: timestamp.c:1645
void CheckPointBuffers(int flags)
Definition: bufmgr.c:4209
void CheckPointCLOG(void)
Definition: clog.c:903
void CheckPointCommitTs(void)
Definition: commit_ts.c:794
void CheckPointMultiXact(void)
Definition: multixact.c:1965
void CheckPointReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition: origin.c:596
void CheckPointPredicate(void)
Definition: predicate.c:1041
void CheckPointRelationMap(void)
Definition: relmapper.c:611
void CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(void)
Definition: rewriteheap.c:1154
void CheckPointReplicationSlots(bool is_shutdown)
Definition: slot.c:2128
void CheckPointSnapBuild(void)
Definition: snapbuild.c:1969
TimestampTz ckpt_write_t
Definition: xlog.h:162
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_end_t
Definition: xlog.h:164
TimestampTz ckpt_sync_t
Definition: xlog.h:163
void CheckPointSUBTRANS(void)
Definition: subtrans.c:329
void ProcessSyncRequests(void)
Definition: sync.c:286
void CheckPointTwoPhase(XLogRecPtr redo_horizon)
Definition: twophase.c:1822
CheckpointStatsData CheckpointStats
Definition: xlog.c:211
#define CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN
Definition: xlog.h:139

References CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN, CheckPointBuffers(), CheckPointCLOG(), CheckPointCommitTs(), CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(), CheckPointMultiXact(), CheckPointPredicate(), CheckPointRelationMap(), CheckPointReplicationOrigin(), CheckPointReplicationSlots(), CheckPointSnapBuild(), CheckpointStats, CheckPointSUBTRANS(), CheckPointTwoPhase(), CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_sync_end_t, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_sync_t, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_write_t, GetCurrentTimestamp(), and ProcessSyncRequests().

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), and CreateRestartPoint().

◆ CheckRequiredParameterValues()

static void CheckRequiredParameterValues ( void  )
static

Definition at line 5437 of file xlog.c.

5438{
5439 /*
5440 * For archive recovery, the WAL must be generated with at least 'replica'
5441 * wal_level.
5442 */
5444 {
5445 ereport(FATAL,
5446 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
5447 errmsg("WAL was generated with \"wal_level=minimal\", cannot continue recovering"),
5448 errdetail("This happens if you temporarily set \"wal_level=minimal\" on the server."),
5449 errhint("Use a backup taken after setting \"wal_level\" to higher than \"minimal\".")));
5450 }
5451
5452 /*
5453 * For Hot Standby, the WAL must be generated with 'replica' mode, and we
5454 * must have at least as many backend slots as the primary.
5455 */
5457 {
5458 /* We ignore autovacuum_worker_slots when we make this test. */
5459 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_connections",
5462 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_worker_processes",
5465 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_wal_senders",
5468 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_prepared_transactions",
5471 RecoveryRequiresIntParameter("max_locks_per_transaction",
5474 }
5475}
int errdetail(const char *fmt,...)
Definition: elog.c:1216
int errhint(const char *fmt,...)
Definition: elog.c:1330
int errcode(int sqlerrcode)
Definition: elog.c:863
#define FATAL
Definition: elog.h:41
int MaxConnections
Definition: globals.c:143
int max_worker_processes
Definition: globals.c:144
int max_locks_per_xact
Definition: lock.c:53
int max_worker_processes
Definition: pg_control.h:181
int max_locks_per_xact
Definition: pg_control.h:184
int max_prepared_xacts
Definition: pg_control.h:183
int max_prepared_xacts
Definition: twophase.c:116
int max_wal_senders
Definition: walsender.c:129
bool EnableHotStandby
Definition: xlog.c:123
@ WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL
Definition: xlog.h:74
bool ArchiveRecoveryRequested
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:140
void RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(const char *param_name, int currValue, int minValue)

References ArchiveRecoveryRequested, ControlFile, EnableHotStandby, ereport, errcode(), errdetail(), errhint(), errmsg(), FATAL, max_locks_per_xact, ControlFileData::max_locks_per_xact, max_prepared_xacts, ControlFileData::max_prepared_xacts, max_wal_senders, ControlFileData::max_wal_senders, max_worker_processes, ControlFileData::max_worker_processes, MaxConnections, ControlFileData::MaxConnections, RecoveryRequiresIntParameter(), ControlFileData::wal_level, and WAL_LEVEL_MINIMAL.

Referenced by StartupXLOG(), and xlog_redo().

◆ CheckXLogRemoved()

void CheckXLogRemoved ( XLogSegNo  segno,
TimeLineID  tli 
)

Definition at line 3748 of file xlog.c.

3749{
3750 int save_errno = errno;
3751 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3752
3754 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3756
3757 if (segno <= lastRemovedSegNo)
3758 {
3759 char filename[MAXFNAMELEN];
3760
3762 errno = save_errno;
3763 ereport(ERROR,
3765 errmsg("requested WAL segment %s has already been removed",
3766 filename)));
3767 }
3768 errno = save_errno;
3769}
#define ERROR
Definition: elog.h:39
static char * filename
Definition: pg_dumpall.c:120
XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo
Definition: xlog.c:462
uint64 XLogSegNo
Definition: xlogdefs.h:52

References ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), ERROR, filename, XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::lastRemovedSegNo, MAXFNAMELEN, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, wal_segment_size, XLogCtl, and XLogFileName().

Referenced by logical_read_xlog_page(), perform_base_backup(), and XLogSendPhysical().

◆ CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery()

static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery ( TimeLineID  EndOfLogTLI,
XLogRecPtr  EndOfLog,
TimeLineID  newTLI 
)
static

Definition at line 5341 of file xlog.c.

5343{
5344 /*
5345 * Execute the recovery_end_command, if any.
5346 */
5347 if (recoveryEndCommand && strcmp(recoveryEndCommand, "") != 0)
5349 "recovery_end_command",
5350 true,
5351 WAIT_EVENT_RECOVERY_END_COMMAND);
5352
5353 /*
5354 * We switched to a new timeline. Clean up segments on the old timeline.
5355 *
5356 * If there are any higher-numbered segments on the old timeline, remove
5357 * them. They might contain valid WAL, but they might also be
5358 * pre-allocated files containing garbage. In any case, they are not part
5359 * of the new timeline's history so we don't need them.
5360 */
5361 RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
5362
5363 /*
5364 * If the switch happened in the middle of a segment, what to do with the
5365 * last, partial segment on the old timeline? If we don't archive it, and
5366 * the server that created the WAL never archives it either (e.g. because
5367 * it was hit by a meteor), it will never make it to the archive. That's
5368 * OK from our point of view, because the new segment that we created with
5369 * the new TLI contains all the WAL from the old timeline up to the switch
5370 * point. But if you later try to do PITR to the "missing" WAL on the old
5371 * timeline, recovery won't find it in the archive. It's physically
5372 * present in the new file with new TLI, but recovery won't look there
5373 * when it's recovering to the older timeline. On the other hand, if we
5374 * archive the partial segment, and the original server on that timeline
5375 * is still running and archives the completed version of the same segment
5376 * later, it will fail. (We used to do that in 9.4 and below, and it
5377 * caused such problems).
5378 *
5379 * As a compromise, we rename the last segment with the .partial suffix,
5380 * and archive it. Archive recovery will never try to read .partial
5381 * segments, so they will normally go unused. But in the odd PITR case,
5382 * the administrator can copy them manually to the pg_wal directory
5383 * (removing the suffix). They can be useful in debugging, too.
5384 *
5385 * If a .done or .ready file already exists for the old timeline, however,
5386 * we had already determined that the segment is complete, so we can let
5387 * it be archived normally. (In particular, if it was restored from the
5388 * archive to begin with, it's expected to have a .done file).
5389 */
5390 if (XLogSegmentOffset(EndOfLog, wal_segment_size) != 0 &&
5392 {
5393 char origfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5394 XLogSegNo endLogSegNo;
5395
5396 XLByteToPrevSeg(EndOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
5397 XLogFileName(origfname, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
5398
5399 if (!XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(origfname))
5400 {
5401 char origpath[MAXPGPATH];
5402 char partialfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5403 char partialpath[MAXPGPATH];
5404
5405 /*
5406 * If we're summarizing WAL, we can't rename the partial file
5407 * until the summarizer finishes with it, else it will fail.
5408 */
5409 if (summarize_wal)
5410 WaitForWalSummarization(EndOfLog);
5411
5412 XLogFilePath(origpath, EndOfLogTLI, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
5413 snprintf(partialfname, MAXFNAMELEN, "%s.partial", origfname);
5414 snprintf(partialpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.partial", origpath);
5415
5416 /*
5417 * Make sure there's no .done or .ready file for the .partial
5418 * file.
5419 */
5420 XLogArchiveCleanup(partialfname);
5421
5422 durable_rename(origpath, partialpath, ERROR);
5423 XLogArchiveNotify(partialfname);
5424 }
5425 }
5426}
int durable_rename(const char *oldfile, const char *newfile, int elevel)
Definition: fd.c:779
#define MAXPGPATH
#define snprintf
Definition: port.h:260
bool summarize_wal
void WaitForWalSummarization(XLogRecPtr lsn)
void RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr switchpoint, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition: xlog.c:3961
#define XLogArchivingActive()
Definition: xlog.h:99
#define XLByteToPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
static void XLogFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)
bool XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(const char *xlog)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:664
void ExecuteRecoveryCommand(const char *command, const char *commandName, bool failOnSignal, uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:295
void XLogArchiveNotify(const char *xlog)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:444
void XLogArchiveCleanup(const char *xlog)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:712
char * recoveryEndCommand
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:86

References durable_rename(), ERROR, ExecuteRecoveryCommand(), MAXFNAMELEN, MAXPGPATH, recoveryEndCommand, RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(), snprintf, summarize_wal, WaitForWalSummarization(), wal_segment_size, XLByteToPrevSeg, XLogArchiveCleanup(), XLogArchiveIsReadyOrDone(), XLogArchiveNotify(), XLogArchivingActive, XLogFileName(), XLogFilePath(), and XLogSegmentOffset.

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ CleanupBackupHistory()

static void CleanupBackupHistory ( void  )
static

Definition at line 4182 of file xlog.c.

4183{
4184 DIR *xldir;
4185 struct dirent *xlde;
4186 char path[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(XLOGDIR)];
4187
4188 xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
4189
4190 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
4191 {
4193 {
4194 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
4195 {
4196 elog(DEBUG2, "removing WAL backup history file \"%s\"",
4197 xlde->d_name);
4198 snprintf(path, sizeof(path), XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
4199 unlink(path);
4201 }
4202 }
4203 }
4204
4205 FreeDir(xldir);
4206}
#define DEBUG2
Definition: elog.h:29
int FreeDir(DIR *dir)
Definition: fd.c:3005
DIR * AllocateDir(const char *dirname)
Definition: fd.c:2887
struct dirent * ReadDir(DIR *dir, const char *dirname)
Definition: fd.c:2953
Definition: dirent.c:26
Definition: dirent.h:10
char d_name[MAX_PATH]
Definition: dirent.h:15
#define XLOGDIR
static bool IsBackupHistoryFileName(const char *fname)
bool XLogArchiveCheckDone(const char *xlog)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:565

References AllocateDir(), dirent::d_name, DEBUG2, elog, FreeDir(), IsBackupHistoryFileName(), MAXPGPATH, ReadDir(), snprintf, XLogArchiveCheckDone(), XLogArchiveCleanup(), and XLOGDIR.

Referenced by do_pg_backup_stop().

◆ CopyXLogRecordToWAL()

static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL ( int  write_len,
bool  isLogSwitch,
XLogRecData rdata,
XLogRecPtr  StartPos,
XLogRecPtr  EndPos,
TimeLineID  tli 
)
static

Definition at line 1231 of file xlog.c.

1233{
1234 char *currpos;
1235 int freespace;
1236 int written;
1237 XLogRecPtr CurrPos;
1238 XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
1239
1240 /*
1241 * Get a pointer to the right place in the right WAL buffer to start
1242 * inserting to.
1243 */
1244 CurrPos = StartPos;
1245 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1246 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1247
1248 /*
1249 * there should be enough space for at least the first field (xl_tot_len)
1250 * on this page.
1251 */
1252 Assert(freespace >= sizeof(uint32));
1253
1254 /* Copy record data */
1255 written = 0;
1256 while (rdata != NULL)
1257 {
1258 const char *rdata_data = rdata->data;
1259 int rdata_len = rdata->len;
1260
1261 while (rdata_len > freespace)
1262 {
1263 /*
1264 * Write what fits on this page, and continue on the next page.
1265 */
1266 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || freespace == 0);
1267 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, freespace);
1268 rdata_data += freespace;
1269 rdata_len -= freespace;
1270 written += freespace;
1271 CurrPos += freespace;
1272
1273 /*
1274 * Get pointer to beginning of next page, and set the xlp_rem_len
1275 * in the page header. Set XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD.
1276 *
1277 * It's safe to set the contrecord flag and xlp_rem_len without a
1278 * lock on the page. All the other flags were already set when the
1279 * page was initialized, in AdvanceXLInsertBuffer, and we're the
1280 * only backend that needs to set the contrecord flag.
1281 */
1282 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1283 pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) currpos;
1284 pagehdr->xlp_rem_len = write_len - written;
1286
1287 /* skip over the page header */
1288 if (XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
1289 {
1290 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1291 currpos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1292 }
1293 else
1294 {
1295 CurrPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1296 currpos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1297 }
1298 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(CurrPos);
1299 }
1300
1301 Assert(CurrPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD || rdata_len == 0);
1302 memcpy(currpos, rdata_data, rdata_len);
1303 currpos += rdata_len;
1304 CurrPos += rdata_len;
1305 freespace -= rdata_len;
1306 written += rdata_len;
1307
1308 rdata = rdata->next;
1309 }
1310 Assert(written == write_len);
1311
1312 /*
1313 * If this was an xlog-switch, it's not enough to write the switch record,
1314 * we also have to consume all the remaining space in the WAL segment. We
1315 * have already reserved that space, but we need to actually fill it.
1316 */
1317 if (isLogSwitch && XLogSegmentOffset(CurrPos, wal_segment_size) != 0)
1318 {
1319 /* An xlog-switch record doesn't contain any data besides the header */
1320 Assert(write_len == SizeOfXLogRecord);
1321
1322 /* Assert that we did reserve the right amount of space */
1324
1325 /* Use up all the remaining space on the current page */
1326 CurrPos += freespace;
1327
1328 /*
1329 * Cause all remaining pages in the segment to be flushed, leaving the
1330 * XLog position where it should be, at the start of the next segment.
1331 * We do this one page at a time, to make sure we don't deadlock
1332 * against ourselves if wal_buffers < wal_segment_size.
1333 */
1334 while (CurrPos < EndPos)
1335 {
1336 /*
1337 * The minimal action to flush the page would be to call
1338 * WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(CurrPos) followed by
1339 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(...). The page would be left initialized
1340 * mostly to zeros, except for the page header (always the short
1341 * variant, as this is never a segment's first page).
1342 *
1343 * The large vistas of zeros are good for compressibility, but the
1344 * headers interrupting them every XLOG_BLCKSZ (with values that
1345 * differ from page to page) are not. The effect varies with
1346 * compression tool, but bzip2 for instance compresses about an
1347 * order of magnitude worse if those headers are left in place.
1348 *
1349 * Rather than complicating AdvanceXLInsertBuffer itself (which is
1350 * called in heavily-loaded circumstances as well as this lightly-
1351 * loaded one) with variant behavior, we just use GetXLogBuffer
1352 * (which itself calls the two methods we need) to get the pointer
1353 * and zero most of the page. Then we just zero the page header.
1354 */
1355 currpos = GetXLogBuffer(CurrPos, tli);
1356 MemSet(currpos, 0, SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1357
1358 CurrPos += XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1359 }
1360 }
1361 else
1362 {
1363 /* Align the end position, so that the next record starts aligned */
1364 CurrPos = MAXALIGN64(CurrPos);
1365 }
1366
1367 if (CurrPos != EndPos)
1368 ereport(PANIC,
1370 errmsg_internal("space reserved for WAL record does not match what was written"));
1371}
uint32_t uint32
Definition: c.h:552
#define MAXALIGN64(LEN)
Definition: c.h:849
int errmsg_internal(const char *fmt,...)
Definition: elog.c:1170
#define ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED
Definition: pg_basebackup.c:42
const void * data
struct XLogRecData * next
#define INSERT_FREESPACE(endptr)
Definition: xlog.c:581
static char * GetXLogBuffer(XLogRecPtr ptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition: xlog.c:1638
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD
Definition: xlog_internal.h:74
#define SizeOfXLogShortPHD
Definition: xlog_internal.h:52

References Assert(), XLogRecData::data, ereport, errcode(), ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED, errmsg_internal(), GetXLogBuffer(), INSERT_FREESPACE, XLogRecData::len, MAXALIGN64, MemSet, XLogRecData::next, PANIC, SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogRecord, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, wal_segment_size, XLogSegmentOffset, XLP_FIRST_IS_CONTRECORD, XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_info, and XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_rem_len.

Referenced by XLogInsertRecord().

◆ CreateCheckPoint()

bool CreateCheckPoint ( int  flags)

Definition at line 6959 of file xlog.c.

6960{
6961 bool shutdown;
6962 CheckPoint checkPoint;
6963 XLogRecPtr recptr;
6964 XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
6966 uint32 freespace;
6967 XLogRecPtr PriorRedoPtr;
6968 XLogRecPtr last_important_lsn;
6969 VirtualTransactionId *vxids;
6970 int nvxids;
6971 int oldXLogAllowed = 0;
6972
6973 /*
6974 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is really a shutdown checkpoint, just
6975 * issued at a different time.
6976 */
6978 shutdown = true;
6979 else
6980 shutdown = false;
6981
6982 /* sanity check */
6983 if (RecoveryInProgress() && (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) == 0)
6984 elog(ERROR, "can't create a checkpoint during recovery");
6985
6986 /*
6987 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
6988 *
6989 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
6990 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
6991 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
6992 */
6995
6996 /*
6997 * Let smgr prepare for checkpoint; this has to happen outside the
6998 * critical section and before we determine the REDO pointer. Note that
6999 * smgr must not do anything that'd have to be undone if we decide no
7000 * checkpoint is needed.
7001 */
7003
7004 /*
7005 * Use a critical section to force system panic if we have trouble.
7006 */
7008
7009 if (shutdown)
7010 {
7011 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
7014 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
7015 }
7016
7017 /* Begin filling in the checkpoint WAL record */
7018 MemSet(&checkPoint, 0, sizeof(checkPoint));
7019 checkPoint.time = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
7020
7021 /*
7022 * For Hot Standby, derive the oldestActiveXid before we fix the redo
7023 * pointer. This allows us to begin accumulating changes to assemble our
7024 * starting snapshot of locks and transactions.
7025 */
7026 if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
7027 checkPoint.oldestActiveXid = GetOldestActiveTransactionId(false, true);
7028 else
7030
7031 /*
7032 * Get location of last important record before acquiring insert locks (as
7033 * GetLastImportantRecPtr() also locks WAL locks).
7034 */
7035 last_important_lsn = GetLastImportantRecPtr();
7036
7037 /*
7038 * If this isn't a shutdown or forced checkpoint, and if there has been no
7039 * WAL activity requiring a checkpoint, skip it. The idea here is to
7040 * avoid inserting duplicate checkpoints when the system is idle.
7041 */
7043 CHECKPOINT_FORCE)) == 0)
7044 {
7045 if (last_important_lsn == ControlFile->checkPoint)
7046 {
7049 (errmsg_internal("checkpoint skipped because system is idle")));
7050 return false;
7051 }
7052 }
7053
7054 /*
7055 * An end-of-recovery checkpoint is created before anyone is allowed to
7056 * write WAL. To allow us to write the checkpoint record, temporarily
7057 * enable XLogInsertAllowed.
7058 */
7059 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7060 oldXLogAllowed = LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed();
7061
7063 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7065 else
7066 checkPoint.PrevTimeLineID = checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID;
7067
7068 /*
7069 * We must block concurrent insertions while examining insert state.
7070 */
7072
7073 checkPoint.fullPageWrites = Insert->fullPageWrites;
7074 checkPoint.wal_level = wal_level;
7075
7076 if (shutdown)
7077 {
7078 XLogRecPtr curInsert = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(Insert->CurrBytePos);
7079
7080 /*
7081 * Compute new REDO record ptr = location of next XLOG record.
7082 *
7083 * Since this is a shutdown checkpoint, there can't be any concurrent
7084 * WAL insertion.
7085 */
7086 freespace = INSERT_FREESPACE(curInsert);
7087 if (freespace == 0)
7088 {
7089 if (XLogSegmentOffset(curInsert, wal_segment_size) == 0)
7090 curInsert += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
7091 else
7092 curInsert += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
7093 }
7094 checkPoint.redo = curInsert;
7095
7096 /*
7097 * Here we update the shared RedoRecPtr for future XLogInsert calls;
7098 * this must be done while holding all the insertion locks.
7099 *
7100 * Note: if we fail to complete the checkpoint, RedoRecPtr will be
7101 * left pointing past where it really needs to point. This is okay;
7102 * the only consequence is that XLogInsert might back up whole buffers
7103 * that it didn't really need to. We can't postpone advancing
7104 * RedoRecPtr because XLogInserts that happen while we are dumping
7105 * buffers must assume that their buffer changes are not included in
7106 * the checkpoint.
7107 */
7108 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7109 }
7110
7111 /*
7112 * Now we can release the WAL insertion locks, allowing other xacts to
7113 * proceed while we are flushing disk buffers.
7114 */
7116
7117 /*
7118 * If this is an online checkpoint, we have not yet determined the redo
7119 * point. We do so now by inserting the special XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7120 * record; the LSN at which it starts becomes the new redo pointer. We
7121 * don't do this for a shutdown checkpoint, because in that case no WAL
7122 * can be written between the redo point and the insertion of the
7123 * checkpoint record itself, so the checkpoint record itself serves to
7124 * mark the redo point.
7125 */
7126 if (!shutdown)
7127 {
7128 /* Include WAL level in record for WAL summarizer's benefit. */
7131 (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO);
7132
7133 /*
7134 * XLogInsertRecord will have updated XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr in
7135 * shared memory and RedoRecPtr in backend-local memory, but we need
7136 * to copy that into the record that will be inserted when the
7137 * checkpoint is complete.
7138 */
7139 checkPoint.redo = RedoRecPtr;
7140 }
7141
7142 /* Update the info_lck-protected copy of RedoRecPtr as well */
7144 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = checkPoint.redo;
7146
7147 /*
7148 * If enabled, log checkpoint start. We postpone this until now so as not
7149 * to log anything if we decided to skip the checkpoint.
7150 */
7151 if (log_checkpoints)
7152 LogCheckpointStart(flags, false);
7153
7154 /* Update the process title */
7155 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, false);
7156
7157 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_START(flags);
7158
7159 /*
7160 * Get the other info we need for the checkpoint record.
7161 *
7162 * We don't need to save oldestClogXid in the checkpoint, it only matters
7163 * for the short period in which clog is being truncated, and if we crash
7164 * during that we'll redo the clog truncation and fix up oldestClogXid
7165 * there.
7166 */
7167 LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
7168 checkPoint.nextXid = TransamVariables->nextXid;
7169 checkPoint.oldestXid = TransamVariables->oldestXid;
7171 LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
7172
7173 LWLockAcquire(CommitTsLock, LW_SHARED);
7176 LWLockRelease(CommitTsLock);
7177
7178 LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_SHARED);
7179 checkPoint.nextOid = TransamVariables->nextOid;
7180 if (!shutdown)
7181 checkPoint.nextOid += TransamVariables->oidCount;
7182 LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
7183
7184 MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(shutdown,
7185 &checkPoint.nextMulti,
7186 &checkPoint.nextMultiOffset,
7187 &checkPoint.oldestMulti,
7188 &checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
7189
7190 /*
7191 * Having constructed the checkpoint record, ensure all shmem disk buffers
7192 * and commit-log buffers are flushed to disk.
7193 *
7194 * This I/O could fail for various reasons. If so, we will fail to
7195 * complete the checkpoint, but there is no reason to force a system
7196 * panic. Accordingly, exit critical section while doing it.
7197 */
7199
7200 /*
7201 * In some cases there are groups of actions that must all occur on one
7202 * side or the other of a checkpoint record. Before flushing the
7203 * checkpoint record we must explicitly wait for any backend currently
7204 * performing those groups of actions.
7205 *
7206 * One example is end of transaction, so we must wait for any transactions
7207 * that are currently in commit critical sections. If an xact inserted
7208 * its commit record into XLOG just before the REDO point, then a crash
7209 * restart from the REDO point would not replay that record, which means
7210 * that our flushing had better include the xact's update of pg_xact. So
7211 * we wait till he's out of his commit critical section before proceeding.
7212 * See notes in RecordTransactionCommit().
7213 *
7214 * Because we've already released the insertion locks, this test is a bit
7215 * fuzzy: it is possible that we will wait for xacts we didn't really need
7216 * to wait for. But the delay should be short and it seems better to make
7217 * checkpoint take a bit longer than to hold off insertions longer than
7218 * necessary. (In fact, the whole reason we have this issue is that xact.c
7219 * does commit record XLOG insertion and clog update as two separate steps
7220 * protected by different locks, but again that seems best on grounds of
7221 * minimizing lock contention.)
7222 *
7223 * A transaction that has not yet set delayChkptFlags when we look cannot
7224 * be at risk, since it has not inserted its commit record yet; and one
7225 * that's already cleared it is not at risk either, since it's done fixing
7226 * clog and we will correctly flush the update below. So we cannot miss
7227 * any xacts we need to wait for.
7228 */
7230 if (nvxids > 0)
7231 {
7232 do
7233 {
7234 /*
7235 * Keep absorbing fsync requests while we wait. There could even
7236 * be a deadlock if we don't, if the process that prevents the
7237 * checkpoint is trying to add a request to the queue.
7238 */
7240
7241 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_START);
7242 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7244 } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
7246 }
7247 pfree(vxids);
7248
7249 CheckPointGuts(checkPoint.redo, flags);
7250
7252 if (nvxids > 0)
7253 {
7254 do
7255 {
7257
7258 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CHECKPOINT_DELAY_COMPLETE);
7259 pg_usleep(10000L); /* wait for 10 msec */
7261 } while (HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(vxids, nvxids,
7263 }
7264 pfree(vxids);
7265
7266 /*
7267 * Take a snapshot of running transactions and write this to WAL. This
7268 * allows us to reconstruct the state of running transactions during
7269 * archive recovery, if required. Skip, if this info disabled.
7270 *
7271 * If we are shutting down, or Startup process is completing crash
7272 * recovery we don't need to write running xact data.
7273 */
7274 if (!shutdown && XLogStandbyInfoActive())
7276
7278
7279 /*
7280 * Now insert the checkpoint record into XLOG.
7281 */
7283 XLogRegisterData(&checkPoint, sizeof(checkPoint));
7284 recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID,
7285 shutdown ? XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN :
7287
7288 XLogFlush(recptr);
7289
7290 /*
7291 * We mustn't write any new WAL after a shutdown checkpoint, or it will be
7292 * overwritten at next startup. No-one should even try, this just allows
7293 * sanity-checking. In the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, we want
7294 * to just temporarily disable writing until the system has exited
7295 * recovery.
7296 */
7297 if (shutdown)
7298 {
7299 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY)
7300 LocalXLogInsertAllowed = oldXLogAllowed;
7301 else
7302 LocalXLogInsertAllowed = 0; /* never again write WAL */
7303 }
7304
7305 /*
7306 * We now have ProcLastRecPtr = start of actual checkpoint record, recptr
7307 * = end of actual checkpoint record.
7308 */
7309 if (shutdown && checkPoint.redo != ProcLastRecPtr)
7310 ereport(PANIC,
7311 (errmsg("concurrent write-ahead log activity while database system is shutting down")));
7312
7313 /*
7314 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7315 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7316 */
7317 PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
7318
7319 /*
7320 * Update the control file.
7321 */
7322 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
7323 if (shutdown)
7326 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = checkPoint;
7327 /* crash recovery should always recover to the end of WAL */
7330
7331 /*
7332 * Persist unloggedLSN value. It's reset on crash recovery, so this goes
7333 * unused on non-shutdown checkpoints, but seems useful to store it always
7334 * for debugging purposes.
7335 */
7337
7339 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
7340
7341 /*
7342 * We are now done with critical updates; no need for system panic if we
7343 * have trouble while fooling with old log segments.
7344 */
7346
7347 /*
7348 * WAL summaries end when the next XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO or
7349 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record is reached. This is the first point
7350 * where (a) we're not inside of a critical section and (b) we can be
7351 * certain that the relevant record has been flushed to disk, which must
7352 * happen before it can be summarized.
7353 *
7354 * If this is a shutdown checkpoint, then this happens reasonably
7355 * promptly: we've only just inserted and flushed the
7356 * XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN record. If this is not a shutdown checkpoint,
7357 * then this might not be very prompt at all: the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
7358 * record was written before we began flushing data to disk, and that
7359 * could be many minutes ago at this point. However, we don't XLogFlush()
7360 * after inserting that record, so we're not guaranteed that it's on disk
7361 * until after the above call that flushes the XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
7362 * record.
7363 */
7365
7366 /*
7367 * Let smgr do post-checkpoint cleanup (eg, deleting old files).
7368 */
7370
7371 /*
7372 * Update the average distance between checkpoints if the prior checkpoint
7373 * exists.
7374 */
7375 if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(PriorRedoPtr))
7377
7378 INJECTION_POINT("checkpoint-before-old-wal-removal", NULL);
7379
7380 /*
7381 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last checkpoint to
7382 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7383 */
7385 KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
7387 _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
7389 {
7390 /*
7391 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7392 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7393 */
7395 KeepLogSeg(recptr, &_logSegNo);
7396 }
7397 _logSegNo--;
7398 RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, recptr,
7399 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
7400
7401 /*
7402 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7403 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7404 */
7405 if (!shutdown)
7406 PreallocXlogFiles(recptr, checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID);
7407
7408 /*
7409 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7410 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7411 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7412 * in subtrans.c). During recovery, though, we mustn't do this because
7413 * StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7414 */
7415 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7417
7418 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7419 LogCheckpointEnd(false);
7420
7421 /* Reset the process title */
7422 update_checkpoint_display(flags, false, true);
7423
7424 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_CHECKPOINT_DONE(CheckpointStats.ckpt_bufs_written,
7425 NBuffers,
7429
7430 return true;
7431}
static uint64 pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr)
Definition: atomics.h:476
void AbsorbSyncRequests(void)
int NBuffers
Definition: globals.c:142
#define INJECTION_POINT(name, arg)
@ LW_SHARED
Definition: lwlock.h:113
#define START_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition: miscadmin.h:150
#define END_CRIT_SECTION()
Definition: miscadmin.h:152
void MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(bool is_shutdown, MultiXactId *nextMulti, MultiXactOffset *nextMultiOffset, MultiXactId *oldestMulti, Oid *oldestMultiDB)
Definition: multixact.c:1943
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO
Definition: pg_control.h:82
@ DB_SHUTDOWNING
Definition: pg_control.h:94
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED
Definition: pg_control.h:92
#define XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE
Definition: pg_control.h:69
#define InvalidOid
Definition: postgres_ext.h:37
#define DELAY_CHKPT_START
Definition: proc.h:135
#define DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE
Definition: proc.h:136
TransactionId GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning(void)
Definition: procarray.c:1982
bool HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(VirtualTransactionId *vxids, int nvxids, int type)
Definition: procarray.c:3050
TransactionId GetOldestActiveTransactionId(bool inCommitOnly, bool allDbs)
Definition: procarray.c:2833
VirtualTransactionId * GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(int *nvxids, int type)
Definition: procarray.c:3005
void pg_usleep(long microsec)
Definition: signal.c:53
bool InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(uint32 possible_causes, XLogSegNo oldestSegno, Oid dboid, TransactionId snapshotConflictHorizon)
Definition: slot.c:2068
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED
Definition: slot.h:62
@ RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT
Definition: slot.h:68
XLogRecPtr LogStandbySnapshot(void)
Definition: standby.c:1282
TimestampTz ckpt_start_t
Definition: xlog.h:161
int ckpt_segs_removed
Definition: xlog.h:171
int ckpt_segs_added
Definition: xlog.h:170
int ckpt_bufs_written
Definition: xlog.h:167
int ckpt_segs_recycled
Definition: xlog.h:172
XLogRecPtr minRecoveryPoint
Definition: pg_control.h:168
XLogRecPtr unloggedLSN
Definition: pg_control.h:137
TimeLineID minRecoveryPointTLI
Definition: pg_control.h:169
TransactionId oldestCommitTsXid
Definition: transam.h:232
TransactionId newestCommitTsXid
Definition: transam.h:233
TransactionId oldestXid
Definition: transam.h:222
TimeLineID InsertTimeLineID
Definition: xlog.c:510
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition: xlog.c:458
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
Definition: xlog.c:511
pg_atomic_uint64 unloggedLSN
Definition: xlog.c:465
XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition: xlog.c:432
void TruncateSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestXact)
Definition: subtrans.c:385
void SyncPreCheckpoint(void)
Definition: sync.c:177
void SyncPostCheckpoint(void)
Definition: sync.c:202
void WakeupWalSummarizer(void)
XLogRecPtr ProcLastRecPtr
Definition: xlog.c:255
bool RecoveryInProgress(void)
Definition: xlog.c:6404
static void WALInsertLockRelease(void)
Definition: xlog.c:1451
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition: xlog.c:1864
static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(void)
Definition: xlog.c:1422
static void UpdateControlFile(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4602
static void RemoveOldXlogFiles(XLogSegNo segno, XLogRecPtr lastredoptr, XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition: xlog.c:3886
static void LogCheckpointStart(int flags, bool restartpoint)
Definition: xlog.c:6719
static XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr
Definition: xlog.c:275
static void LogCheckpointEnd(bool restartpoint)
Definition: xlog.c:6751
static void PreallocXlogFiles(XLogRecPtr endptr, TimeLineID tli)
Definition: xlog.c:3711
bool log_checkpoints
Definition: xlog.c:131
static void KeepLogSeg(XLogRecPtr recptr, XLogSegNo *logSegNo)
Definition: xlog.c:8019
static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition: xlog.c:6492
XLogRecPtr GetLastImportantRecPtr(void)
Definition: xlog.c:6626
static void UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(uint64 nbytes)
Definition: xlog.c:6856
static int LocalXLogInsertAllowed
Definition: xlog.c:238
void XLogFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition: xlog.c:2783
static void CheckPointGuts(XLogRecPtr checkPointRedo, int flags)
Definition: xlog.c:7577
static void update_checkpoint_display(int flags, bool restartpoint, bool reset)
Definition: xlog.c:6894
#define CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition: xlog.h:140
#define CHECKPOINT_FORCE
Definition: xlog.h:142
#define XLogStandbyInfoActive()
Definition: xlog.h:123
#define XLByteToSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)
#define XLogRecPtrIsValid(r)
Definition: xlogdefs.h:29
XLogRecPtr XLogInsert(RmgrId rmid, uint8 info)
Definition: xloginsert.c:478
void XLogRegisterData(const void *data, uint32 len)
Definition: xloginsert.c:368
void XLogBeginInsert(void)
Definition: xloginsert.c:152

References AbsorbSyncRequests(), ControlFileData::checkPoint, CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY, CHECKPOINT_FORCE, CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN, ControlFileData::checkPointCopy, CheckPointGuts(), CheckpointStats, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_bufs_written, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_added, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_recycled, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_removed, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_start_t, ControlFile, DB_SHUTDOWNED, DB_SHUTDOWNING, DEBUG1, DELAY_CHKPT_COMPLETE, DELAY_CHKPT_START, elog, END_CRIT_SECTION, ereport, errmsg(), errmsg_internal(), ERROR, CheckPoint::fullPageWrites, GetCurrentTimestamp(), GetLastImportantRecPtr(), GetOldestActiveTransactionId(), GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning(), GetVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(), HaveVirtualXIDsDelayingChkpt(), XLogCtlData::info_lck, INJECTION_POINT, XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), INSERT_FREESPACE, XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(), InvalidOid, InvalidTransactionId, InvalidXLogRecPtr, KeepLogSeg(), LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(), LocalXLogInsertAllowed, log_checkpoints, LogCheckpointEnd(), LogCheckpointStart(), LogStandbySnapshot(), LW_EXCLUSIVE, LW_SHARED, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), MemSet, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, MultiXactGetCheckptMulti(), NBuffers, TransamVariablesData::newestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::newestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::nextMulti, CheckPoint::nextMultiOffset, TransamVariablesData::nextOid, CheckPoint::nextOid, TransamVariablesData::nextXid, CheckPoint::nextXid, TransamVariablesData::oidCount, CheckPoint::oldestActiveXid, TransamVariablesData::oldestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::oldestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::oldestMulti, CheckPoint::oldestMultiDB, TransamVariablesData::oldestXid, CheckPoint::oldestXid, TransamVariablesData::oldestXidDB, CheckPoint::oldestXidDB, PANIC, pfree(), pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(), pg_usleep(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), PreallocXlogFiles(), XLogCtlData::PrevTimeLineID, CheckPoint::PrevTimeLineID, ProcLastRecPtr, RecoveryInProgress(), CheckPoint::redo, RedoRecPtr, XLogCtlInsert::RedoRecPtr, XLogCtlData::RedoRecPtr, RemoveOldXlogFiles(), RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT, RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED, SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, START_CRIT_SECTION, ControlFileData::state, SyncPostCheckpoint(), SyncPreCheckpoint(), CheckPoint::ThisTimeLineID, CheckPoint::time, TransamVariables, TruncateSUBTRANS(), XLogCtlData::unloggedLSN, ControlFileData::unloggedLSN, update_checkpoint_display(), UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(), UpdateControlFile(), WakeupWalSummarizer(), wal_level, CheckPoint::wal_level, wal_segment_size, WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), XLByteToSeg, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogBytePosToRecPtr(), XLogCtl, XLogFlush(), XLogInsert(), XLogRecPtrIsValid, XLogRegisterData(), XLogSegmentOffset, and XLogStandbyInfoActive.

Referenced by CheckpointerMain(), RequestCheckpoint(), and ShutdownXLOG().

◆ CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord()

static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord ( void  )
static

Definition at line 7442 of file xlog.c.

7443{
7444 xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
7445 XLogRecPtr recptr;
7446
7447 /* sanity check */
7448 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7449 elog(ERROR, "can only be used to end recovery");
7450
7451 xlrec.end_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
7452 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
7453
7458
7460
7462 XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
7463 recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY);
7464
7465 XLogFlush(recptr);
7466
7467 /*
7468 * Update the control file so that crash recovery can follow the timeline
7469 * changes to this point.
7470 */
7471 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
7472 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = recptr;
7475 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
7476
7478}
#define XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY
Definition: pg_control.h:77
TimeLineID PrevTimeLineID
TimestampTz end_time
TimeLineID ThisTimeLineID

References ControlFile, elog, END_CRIT_SECTION, xl_end_of_recovery::end_time, ERROR, GetCurrentTimestamp(), XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, XLogCtlData::PrevTimeLineID, xl_end_of_recovery::PrevTimeLineID, RecoveryInProgress(), START_CRIT_SECTION, xl_end_of_recovery::ThisTimeLineID, UpdateControlFile(), wal_level, xl_end_of_recovery::wal_level, WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogCtl, XLogFlush(), XLogInsert(), and XLogRegisterData().

Referenced by PerformRecoveryXLogAction().

◆ CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord()

static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord ( XLogRecPtr  aborted_lsn,
XLogRecPtr  pagePtr,
TimeLineID  newTLI 
)
static

Definition at line 7507 of file xlog.c.

7509{
7511 XLogRecPtr recptr;
7512 XLogPageHeader pagehdr;
7513 XLogRecPtr startPos;
7514
7515 /* sanity checks */
7516 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7517 elog(ERROR, "can only be used at end of recovery");
7518 if (pagePtr % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
7519 elog(ERROR, "invalid position for missing continuation record %X/%08X",
7520 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(pagePtr));
7521
7522 /* The current WAL insert position should be right after the page header */
7523 startPos = pagePtr;
7524 if (XLogSegmentOffset(startPos, wal_segment_size) == 0)
7525 startPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
7526 else
7527 startPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
7528 recptr = GetXLogInsertRecPtr();
7529 if (recptr != startPos)
7530 elog(ERROR, "invalid WAL insert position %X/%08X for OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD",
7531 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(recptr));
7532
7534
7535 /*
7536 * Initialize the XLOG page header (by GetXLogBuffer), and set the
7537 * XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD flag.
7538 *
7539 * No other backend is allowed to write WAL yet, so acquiring the WAL
7540 * insertion lock is just pro forma.
7541 */
7543 pagehdr = (XLogPageHeader) GetXLogBuffer(pagePtr, newTLI);
7546
7547 /*
7548 * Insert the XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD record as the first record on the
7549 * page. We know it becomes the first record, because no other backend is
7550 * allowed to write WAL yet.
7551 */
7553 xlrec.overwritten_lsn = aborted_lsn;
7556 recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD);
7557
7558 /* check that the record was inserted to the right place */
7559 if (ProcLastRecPtr != startPos)
7560 elog(ERROR, "OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD was inserted to unexpected position %X/%08X",
7562
7563 XLogFlush(recptr);
7564
7566
7567 return recptr;
7568}
#define XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
Definition: pg_control.h:81
static void WALInsertLockAcquire(void)
Definition: xlog.c:1377
XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertRecPtr(void)
Definition: xlog.c:9497
#define XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD
Definition: xlog_internal.h:80

References elog, END_CRIT_SECTION, ERROR, GetCurrentTimestamp(), GetXLogBuffer(), GetXLogInsertRecPtr(), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, xl_overwrite_contrecord::overwrite_time, xl_overwrite_contrecord::overwritten_lsn, ProcLastRecPtr, RecoveryInProgress(), SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, START_CRIT_SECTION, wal_segment_size, WALInsertLockAcquire(), WALInsertLockRelease(), XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogFlush(), XLogInsert(), XLogRegisterData(), XLogSegmentOffset, XLP_FIRST_IS_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD, and XLogPageHeaderData::xlp_info.

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ CreateRestartPoint()

bool CreateRestartPoint ( int  flags)

Definition at line 7657 of file xlog.c.

7658{
7659 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7660 XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7661 CheckPoint lastCheckPoint;
7662 XLogRecPtr PriorRedoPtr;
7663 XLogRecPtr receivePtr;
7664 XLogRecPtr replayPtr;
7665 TimeLineID replayTLI;
7666 XLogRecPtr endptr;
7667 XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
7668 TimestampTz xtime;
7669
7670 /* Concurrent checkpoint/restartpoint cannot happen */
7672
7673 /* Get a local copy of the last safe checkpoint record. */
7675 lastCheckPointRecPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7676 lastCheckPointEndPtr = XLogCtl->lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7677 lastCheckPoint = XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint;
7679
7680 /*
7681 * Check that we're still in recovery mode. It's ok if we exit recovery
7682 * mode after this check, the restart point is valid anyway.
7683 */
7684 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7685 {
7687 (errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, recovery has already ended")));
7688 return false;
7689 }
7690
7691 /*
7692 * If the last checkpoint record we've replayed is already our last
7693 * restartpoint, we can't perform a new restart point. We still update
7694 * minRecoveryPoint in that case, so that if this is a shutdown restart
7695 * point, we won't start up earlier than before. That's not strictly
7696 * necessary, but when hot standby is enabled, it would be rather weird if
7697 * the database opened up for read-only connections at a point-in-time
7698 * before the last shutdown. Such time travel is still possible in case of
7699 * immediate shutdown, though.
7700 *
7701 * We don't explicitly advance minRecoveryPoint when we do create a
7702 * restartpoint. It's assumed that flushing the buffers will do that as a
7703 * side-effect.
7704 */
7705 if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(lastCheckPointRecPtr) ||
7706 lastCheckPoint.redo <= ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo)
7707 {
7709 errmsg_internal("skipping restartpoint, already performed at %X/%08X",
7710 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)));
7711
7713 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7714 {
7715 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
7718 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
7719 }
7720 return false;
7721 }
7722
7723 /*
7724 * Update the shared RedoRecPtr so that the startup process can calculate
7725 * the number of segments replayed since last restartpoint, and request a
7726 * restartpoint if it exceeds CheckPointSegments.
7727 *
7728 * Like in CreateCheckPoint(), hold off insertions to update it, although
7729 * during recovery this is just pro forma, because no WAL insertions are
7730 * happening.
7731 */
7733 RedoRecPtr = XLogCtl->Insert.RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7735
7736 /* Also update the info_lck-protected copy */
7738 XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr = lastCheckPoint.redo;
7740
7741 /*
7742 * Prepare to accumulate statistics.
7743 *
7744 * Note: because it is possible for log_checkpoints to change while a
7745 * checkpoint proceeds, we always accumulate stats, even if
7746 * log_checkpoints is currently off.
7747 */
7750
7751 if (log_checkpoints)
7752 LogCheckpointStart(flags, true);
7753
7754 /* Update the process title */
7755 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, false);
7756
7757 CheckPointGuts(lastCheckPoint.redo, flags);
7758
7759 /*
7760 * This location needs to be after CheckPointGuts() to ensure that some
7761 * work has already happened during this checkpoint.
7762 */
7763 INJECTION_POINT("create-restart-point", NULL);
7764
7765 /*
7766 * Remember the prior checkpoint's redo ptr for
7767 * UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()
7768 */
7769 PriorRedoPtr = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
7770
7771 /*
7772 * Update pg_control, using current time. Check that it still shows an
7773 * older checkpoint, else do nothing; this is a quick hack to make sure
7774 * nothing really bad happens if somehow we get here after the
7775 * end-of-recovery checkpoint.
7776 */
7777 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
7778 if (ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo < lastCheckPoint.redo)
7779 {
7780 /*
7781 * Update the checkpoint information. We do this even if the cluster
7782 * does not show DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY to match with the set of WAL
7783 * segments recycled below.
7784 */
7785 ControlFile->checkPoint = lastCheckPointRecPtr;
7786 ControlFile->checkPointCopy = lastCheckPoint;
7787
7788 /*
7789 * Ensure minRecoveryPoint is past the checkpoint record and update it
7790 * if the control file still shows DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY. Normally,
7791 * this will have happened already while writing out dirty buffers,
7792 * but not necessarily - e.g. because no buffers were dirtied. We do
7793 * this because a backup performed in recovery uses minRecoveryPoint
7794 * to determine which WAL files must be included in the backup, and
7795 * the file (or files) containing the checkpoint record must be
7796 * included, at a minimum. Note that for an ordinary restart of
7797 * recovery there's no value in having the minimum recovery point any
7798 * earlier than this anyway, because redo will begin just after the
7799 * checkpoint record.
7800 */
7802 {
7803 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < lastCheckPointEndPtr)
7804 {
7805 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = lastCheckPointEndPtr;
7807
7808 /* update local copy */
7811 }
7812 if (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN)
7814 }
7816 }
7817 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
7818
7819 /*
7820 * Update the average distance between checkpoints/restartpoints if the
7821 * prior checkpoint exists.
7822 */
7823 if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(PriorRedoPtr))
7825
7826 /*
7827 * Delete old log files, those no longer needed for last restartpoint to
7828 * prevent the disk holding the xlog from growing full.
7829 */
7831
7832 /*
7833 * Retreat _logSegNo using the current end of xlog replayed or received,
7834 * whichever is later.
7835 */
7836 receivePtr = GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(NULL, NULL);
7837 replayPtr = GetXLogReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
7838 endptr = (receivePtr < replayPtr) ? replayPtr : receivePtr;
7839 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7841 _logSegNo, InvalidOid,
7843 {
7844 /*
7845 * Some slots have been invalidated; recalculate the old-segment
7846 * horizon, starting again from RedoRecPtr.
7847 */
7849 KeepLogSeg(endptr, &_logSegNo);
7850 }
7851 _logSegNo--;
7852
7853 /*
7854 * Try to recycle segments on a useful timeline. If we've been promoted
7855 * since the beginning of this restartpoint, use the new timeline chosen
7856 * at end of recovery. If we're still in recovery, use the timeline we're
7857 * currently replaying.
7858 *
7859 * There is no guarantee that the WAL segments will be useful on the
7860 * current timeline; if recovery proceeds to a new timeline right after
7861 * this, the pre-allocated WAL segments on this timeline will not be used,
7862 * and will go wasted until recycled on the next restartpoint. We'll live
7863 * with that.
7864 */
7865 if (!RecoveryInProgress())
7866 replayTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
7867
7868 RemoveOldXlogFiles(_logSegNo, RedoRecPtr, endptr, replayTLI);
7869
7870 /*
7871 * Make more log segments if needed. (Do this after recycling old log
7872 * segments, since that may supply some of the needed files.)
7873 */
7874 PreallocXlogFiles(endptr, replayTLI);
7875
7876 /*
7877 * Truncate pg_subtrans if possible. We can throw away all data before
7878 * the oldest XMIN of any running transaction. No future transaction will
7879 * attempt to reference any pg_subtrans entry older than that (see Asserts
7880 * in subtrans.c). When hot standby is disabled, though, we mustn't do
7881 * this because StartupSUBTRANS hasn't been called yet.
7882 */
7883 if (EnableHotStandby)
7885
7886 /* Real work is done; log and update stats. */
7887 LogCheckpointEnd(true);
7888
7889 /* Reset the process title */
7890 update_checkpoint_display(flags, true, true);
7891
7892 xtime = GetLatestXTime();
7894 errmsg("recovery restart point at %X/%08X",
7895 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lastCheckPoint.redo)),
7896 xtime ? errdetail("Last completed transaction was at log time %s.",
7897 timestamptz_to_str(xtime)) : 0);
7898
7899 /*
7900 * Finally, execute archive_cleanup_command, if any.
7901 */
7902 if (archiveCleanupCommand && strcmp(archiveCleanupCommand, "") != 0)
7904 "archive_cleanup_command",
7905 false,
7906 WAIT_EVENT_ARCHIVE_CLEANUP_COMMAND);
7907
7908 return true;
7909}
const char * timestamptz_to_str(TimestampTz t)
Definition: timestamp.c:1862
int64 TimestampTz
Definition: timestamp.h:39
bool IsUnderPostmaster
Definition: globals.c:120
@ B_CHECKPOINTER
Definition: miscadmin.h:363
BackendType MyBackendType
Definition: miscinit.c:64
@ DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY
Definition: pg_control.h:96
@ DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY
Definition: pg_control.h:93
CheckPoint lastCheckPoint
Definition: xlog.c:546
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointRecPtr
Definition: xlog.c:544
XLogRecPtr lastCheckPointEndPtr
Definition: xlog.c:545
XLogRecPtr GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(XLogRecPtr *latestChunkStart, TimeLineID *receiveTLI)
static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(XLogRecPtr lsn, bool force)
Definition: xlog.c:2703
static XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint
Definition: xlog.c:647
static TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI
Definition: xlog.c:648
uint32 TimeLineID
Definition: xlogdefs.h:63
char * archiveCleanupCommand
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:87
XLogRecPtr GetXLogReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayTLI)
TimestampTz GetLatestXTime(void)

References archiveCleanupCommand, Assert(), B_CHECKPOINTER, ControlFileData::checkPoint, CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN, ControlFileData::checkPointCopy, CheckPointGuts(), CheckpointStats, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_start_t, ControlFile, DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY, DEBUG2, EnableHotStandby, ereport, errdetail(), errmsg(), errmsg_internal(), ExecuteRecoveryCommand(), GetCurrentTimestamp(), GetLatestXTime(), GetOldestTransactionIdConsideredRunning(), GetWalRcvFlushRecPtr(), GetXLogReplayRecPtr(), XLogCtlData::info_lck, INJECTION_POINT, XLogCtlData::Insert, XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(), InvalidOid, InvalidTransactionId, InvalidXLogRecPtr, IsUnderPostmaster, KeepLogSeg(), XLogCtlData::lastCheckPoint, XLogCtlData::lastCheckPointEndPtr, XLogCtlData::lastCheckPointRecPtr, LocalMinRecoveryPoint, LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI, LOG, log_checkpoints, LogCheckpointEnd(), LogCheckpointStart(), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), MemSet, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, MyBackendType, PreallocXlogFiles(), RecoveryInProgress(), CheckPoint::redo, RedoRecPtr, XLogCtlInsert::RedoRecPtr, XLogCtlData::RedoRecPtr, RemoveOldXlogFiles(), RS_INVAL_IDLE_TIMEOUT, RS_INVAL_WAL_REMOVED, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, ControlFileData::state, CheckPoint::ThisTimeLineID, timestamptz_to_str(), TruncateSUBTRANS(), update_checkpoint_display(), UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(), UpdateControlFile(), UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(), wal_segment_size, WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), XLByteToSeg, XLogCtl, and XLogRecPtrIsValid.

Referenced by CheckpointerMain(), and ShutdownXLOG().

◆ DataChecksumsEnabled()

◆ do_pg_abort_backup()

void do_pg_abort_backup ( int  code,
Datum  arg 
)

Definition at line 9456 of file xlog.c.

9457{
9458 bool during_backup_start = DatumGetBool(arg);
9459
9460 /* If called during backup start, there shouldn't be one already running */
9461 Assert(!during_backup_start || sessionBackupState == SESSION_BACKUP_NONE);
9462
9463 if (during_backup_start || sessionBackupState != SESSION_BACKUP_NONE)
9464 {
9468
9471
9472 if (!during_backup_start)
9474 errmsg("aborting backup due to backend exiting before pg_backup_stop was called"));
9475 }
9476}
#define WARNING
Definition: elog.h:36
void * arg
static bool DatumGetBool(Datum X)
Definition: postgres.h:100
int runningBackups
Definition: xlog.c:440
static SessionBackupState sessionBackupState
Definition: xlog.c:393
@ SESSION_BACKUP_NONE
Definition: xlog.h:290

References arg, Assert(), DatumGetBool(), ereport, errmsg(), XLogCtlData::Insert, XLogCtlInsert::runningBackups, SESSION_BACKUP_NONE, sessionBackupState, WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), WARNING, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by do_pg_backup_start(), perform_base_backup(), and register_persistent_abort_backup_handler().

◆ do_pg_backup_start()

void do_pg_backup_start ( const char *  backupidstr,
bool  fast,
List **  tablespaces,
BackupState state,
StringInfo  tblspcmapfile 
)

Definition at line 8854 of file xlog.c.

8856{
8858
8859 Assert(state != NULL);
8861
8862 /*
8863 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
8864 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
8865 */
8867 ereport(ERROR,
8868 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
8869 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
8870 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
8871
8872 if (strlen(backupidstr) > MAXPGPATH)
8873 ereport(ERROR,
8874 (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
8875 errmsg("backup label too long (max %d bytes)",
8876 MAXPGPATH)));
8877
8878 strlcpy(state->name, backupidstr, sizeof(state->name));
8879
8880 /*
8881 * Mark backup active in shared memory. We must do full-page WAL writes
8882 * during an on-line backup even if not doing so at other times, because
8883 * it's quite possible for the backup dump to obtain a "torn" (partially
8884 * written) copy of a database page if it reads the page concurrently with
8885 * our write to the same page. This can be fixed as long as the first
8886 * write to the page in the WAL sequence is a full-page write. Hence, we
8887 * increment runningBackups then force a CHECKPOINT, to ensure there are
8888 * no dirty pages in shared memory that might get dumped while the backup
8889 * is in progress without having a corresponding WAL record. (Once the
8890 * backup is complete, we need not force full-page writes anymore, since
8891 * we expect that any pages not modified during the backup interval must
8892 * have been correctly captured by the backup.)
8893 *
8894 * Note that forcing full-page writes has no effect during an online
8895 * backup from the standby.
8896 *
8897 * We must hold all the insertion locks to change the value of
8898 * runningBackups, to ensure adequate interlocking against
8899 * XLogInsertRecord().
8900 */
8904
8905 /*
8906 * Ensure we decrement runningBackups if we fail below. NB -- for this to
8907 * work correctly, it is critical that sessionBackupState is only updated
8908 * after this block is over.
8909 */
8911 {
8912 bool gotUniqueStartpoint = false;
8913 DIR *tblspcdir;
8914 struct dirent *de;
8915 tablespaceinfo *ti;
8916 int datadirpathlen;
8917
8918 /*
8919 * Force an XLOG file switch before the checkpoint, to ensure that the
8920 * WAL segment the checkpoint is written to doesn't contain pages with
8921 * old timeline IDs. That would otherwise happen if you called
8922 * pg_backup_start() right after restoring from a PITR archive: the
8923 * first WAL segment containing the startup checkpoint has pages in
8924 * the beginning with the old timeline ID. That can cause trouble at
8925 * recovery: we won't have a history file covering the old timeline if
8926 * pg_wal directory was not included in the base backup and the WAL
8927 * archive was cleared too before starting the backup.
8928 *
8929 * This also ensures that we have emitted a WAL page header that has
8930 * XLP_BKP_REMOVABLE off before we emit the checkpoint record.
8931 * Therefore, if a WAL archiver (such as pglesslog) is trying to
8932 * compress out removable backup blocks, it won't remove any that
8933 * occur after this point.
8934 *
8935 * During recovery, we skip forcing XLOG file switch, which means that
8936 * the backup taken during recovery is not available for the special
8937 * recovery case described above.
8938 */
8940 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
8941
8942 do
8943 {
8944 bool checkpointfpw;
8945
8946 /*
8947 * Force a CHECKPOINT. Aside from being necessary to prevent torn
8948 * page problems, this guarantees that two successive backup runs
8949 * will have different checkpoint positions and hence different
8950 * history file names, even if nothing happened in between.
8951 *
8952 * During recovery, establish a restartpoint if possible. We use
8953 * the last restartpoint as the backup starting checkpoint. This
8954 * means that two successive backup runs can have same checkpoint
8955 * positions.
8956 *
8957 * Since the fact that we are executing do_pg_backup_start()
8958 * during recovery means that checkpointer is running, we can use
8959 * RequestCheckpoint() to establish a restartpoint.
8960 *
8961 * We use CHECKPOINT_FAST only if requested by user (via passing
8962 * fast = true). Otherwise this can take awhile.
8963 */
8965 (fast ? CHECKPOINT_FAST : 0));
8966
8967 /*
8968 * Now we need to fetch the checkpoint record location, and also
8969 * its REDO pointer. The oldest point in WAL that would be needed
8970 * to restore starting from the checkpoint is precisely the REDO
8971 * pointer.
8972 */
8973 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
8974 state->checkpointloc = ControlFile->checkPoint;
8975 state->startpoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.redo;
8977 checkpointfpw = ControlFile->checkPointCopy.fullPageWrites;
8978 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
8979
8981 {
8982 XLogRecPtr recptr;
8983
8984 /*
8985 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup
8986 * (i.e., since last restartpoint used as backup starting
8987 * checkpoint) contain full-page writes.
8988 */
8990 recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
8992
8993 if (!checkpointfpw || state->startpoint <= recptr)
8994 ereport(ERROR,
8995 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
8996 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
8997 "since last restartpoint"),
8998 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
8999 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9000 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9001 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9002
9003 /*
9004 * During recovery, since we don't use the end-of-backup WAL
9005 * record and don't write the backup history file, the
9006 * starting WAL location doesn't need to be unique. This means
9007 * that two base backups started at the same time might use
9008 * the same checkpoint as starting locations.
9009 */
9010 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9011 }
9012
9013 /*
9014 * If two base backups are started at the same time (in WAL sender
9015 * processes), we need to make sure that they use different
9016 * checkpoints as starting locations, because we use the starting
9017 * WAL location as a unique identifier for the base backup in the
9018 * end-of-backup WAL record and when we write the backup history
9019 * file. Perhaps it would be better generate a separate unique ID
9020 * for each backup instead of forcing another checkpoint, but
9021 * taking a checkpoint right after another is not that expensive
9022 * either because only few buffers have been dirtied yet.
9023 */
9025 if (XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart < state->startpoint)
9026 {
9027 XLogCtl->Insert.lastBackupStart = state->startpoint;
9028 gotUniqueStartpoint = true;
9029 }
9031 } while (!gotUniqueStartpoint);
9032
9033 /*
9034 * Construct tablespace_map file.
9035 */
9036 datadirpathlen = strlen(DataDir);
9037
9038 /* Collect information about all tablespaces */
9039 tblspcdir = AllocateDir(PG_TBLSPC_DIR);
9040 while ((de = ReadDir(tblspcdir, PG_TBLSPC_DIR)) != NULL)
9041 {
9042 char fullpath[MAXPGPATH + sizeof(PG_TBLSPC_DIR)];
9043 char linkpath[MAXPGPATH];
9044 char *relpath = NULL;
9045 char *s;
9046 PGFileType de_type;
9047 char *badp;
9048 Oid tsoid;
9049
9050 /*
9051 * Try to parse the directory name as an unsigned integer.
9052 *
9053 * Tablespace directories should be positive integers that can be
9054 * represented in 32 bits, with no leading zeroes or trailing
9055 * garbage. If we come across a name that doesn't meet those
9056 * criteria, skip it.
9057 */
9058 if (de->d_name[0] < '1' || de->d_name[1] > '9')
9059 continue;
9060 errno = 0;
9061 tsoid = strtoul(de->d_name, &badp, 10);
9062 if (*badp != '\0' || errno == EINVAL || errno == ERANGE)
9063 continue;
9064
9065 snprintf(fullpath, sizeof(fullpath), "%s/%s", PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9066
9067 de_type = get_dirent_type(fullpath, de, false, ERROR);
9068
9069 if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_LNK)
9070 {
9071 StringInfoData escapedpath;
9072 int rllen;
9073
9074 rllen = readlink(fullpath, linkpath, sizeof(linkpath));
9075 if (rllen < 0)
9076 {
9078 (errmsg("could not read symbolic link \"%s\": %m",
9079 fullpath)));
9080 continue;
9081 }
9082 else if (rllen >= sizeof(linkpath))
9083 {
9085 (errmsg("symbolic link \"%s\" target is too long",
9086 fullpath)));
9087 continue;
9088 }
9089 linkpath[rllen] = '\0';
9090
9091 /*
9092 * Relpath holds the relative path of the tablespace directory
9093 * when it's located within PGDATA, or NULL if it's located
9094 * elsewhere.
9095 */
9096 if (rllen > datadirpathlen &&
9097 strncmp(linkpath, DataDir, datadirpathlen) == 0 &&
9098 IS_DIR_SEP(linkpath[datadirpathlen]))
9099 relpath = pstrdup(linkpath + datadirpathlen + 1);
9100
9101 /*
9102 * Add a backslash-escaped version of the link path to the
9103 * tablespace map file.
9104 */
9105 initStringInfo(&escapedpath);
9106 for (s = linkpath; *s; s++)
9107 {
9108 if (*s == '\n' || *s == '\r' || *s == '\\')
9109 appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, '\\');
9110 appendStringInfoChar(&escapedpath, *s);
9111 }
9112 appendStringInfo(tblspcmapfile, "%s %s\n",
9113 de->d_name, escapedpath.data);
9114 pfree(escapedpath.data);
9115 }
9116 else if (de_type == PGFILETYPE_DIR)
9117 {
9118 /*
9119 * It's possible to use allow_in_place_tablespaces to create
9120 * directories directly under pg_tblspc, for testing purposes
9121 * only.
9122 *
9123 * In this case, we store a relative path rather than an
9124 * absolute path into the tablespaceinfo.
9125 */
9126 snprintf(linkpath, sizeof(linkpath), "%s/%s",
9127 PG_TBLSPC_DIR, de->d_name);
9128 relpath = pstrdup(linkpath);
9129 }
9130 else
9131 {
9132 /* Skip any other file type that appears here. */
9133 continue;
9134 }
9135
9137 ti->oid = tsoid;
9138 ti->path = pstrdup(linkpath);
9139 ti->rpath = relpath;
9140 ti->size = -1;
9141
9142 if (tablespaces)
9143 *tablespaces = lappend(*tablespaces, ti);
9144 }
9145 FreeDir(tblspcdir);
9146
9147 state->starttime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9148 }
9150
9151 state->started_in_recovery = backup_started_in_recovery;
9152
9153 /*
9154 * Mark that the start phase has correctly finished for the backup.
9155 */
9157}
static bool backup_started_in_recovery
Definition: basebackup.c:123
void RequestCheckpoint(int flags)
#define palloc_object(type)
Definition: fe_memutils.h:74
PGFileType get_dirent_type(const char *path, const struct dirent *de, bool look_through_symlinks, int elevel)
Definition: file_utils.c:547
PGFileType
Definition: file_utils.h:19
@ PGFILETYPE_LNK
Definition: file_utils.h:24
@ PGFILETYPE_DIR
Definition: file_utils.h:23
char * DataDir
Definition: globals.c:71
#define PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition: ipc.h:47
#define PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP(cleanup_function, arg)
Definition: ipc.h:52
List * lappend(List *list, void *datum)
Definition: list.c:339
#define IS_DIR_SEP(ch)
Definition: port.h:103
size_t strlcpy(char *dst, const char *src, size_t siz)
Definition: strlcpy.c:45
static Datum BoolGetDatum(bool X)
Definition: postgres.h:112
unsigned int Oid
Definition: postgres_ext.h:32
#define relpath(rlocator, forknum)
Definition: relpath.h:150
#define PG_TBLSPC_DIR
Definition: relpath.h:41
void appendStringInfo(StringInfo str, const char *fmt,...)
Definition: stringinfo.c:145
void appendStringInfoChar(StringInfo str, char ch)
Definition: stringinfo.c:242
void initStringInfo(StringInfo str)
Definition: stringinfo.c:97
XLogRecPtr lastFpwDisableRecPtr
Definition: xlog.c:552
XLogRecPtr lastBackupStart
Definition: xlog.c:441
Definition: regguts.h:323
char * rpath
Definition: basebackup.h:32
#define readlink(path, buf, size)
Definition: win32_port.h:226
XLogRecPtr RequestXLogSwitch(bool mark_unimportant)
Definition: xlog.c:8128
void do_pg_abort_backup(int code, Datum arg)
Definition: xlog.c:9456
@ SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING
Definition: xlog.h:291
#define CHECKPOINT_WAIT
Definition: xlog.h:145
#define CHECKPOINT_FAST
Definition: xlog.h:141
#define XLogIsNeeded()
Definition: xlog.h:109

References AllocateDir(), appendStringInfo(), appendStringInfoChar(), Assert(), backup_started_in_recovery, BoolGetDatum(), ControlFileData::checkPoint, CHECKPOINT_FAST, CHECKPOINT_FORCE, CHECKPOINT_WAIT, ControlFileData::checkPointCopy, ControlFile, dirent::d_name, StringInfoData::data, DataDir, do_pg_abort_backup(), ereport, errcode(), errhint(), errmsg(), ERROR, FreeDir(), CheckPoint::fullPageWrites, get_dirent_type(), XLogCtlData::info_lck, initStringInfo(), XLogCtlData::Insert, IS_DIR_SEP, lappend(), XLogCtlInsert::lastBackupStart, XLogCtlData::lastFpwDisableRecPtr, LW_SHARED, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), MAXPGPATH, tablespaceinfo::oid, palloc_object, tablespaceinfo::path, pfree(), PG_END_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP, PG_ENSURE_ERROR_CLEANUP, PG_TBLSPC_DIR, PGFILETYPE_DIR, PGFILETYPE_LNK, pstrdup(), ReadDir(), readlink, RecoveryInProgress(), CheckPoint::redo, relpath, RequestCheckpoint(), RequestXLogSwitch(), tablespaceinfo::rpath, XLogCtlInsert::runningBackups, SESSION_BACKUP_RUNNING, sessionBackupState, tablespaceinfo::size, snprintf, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, strlcpy(), CheckPoint::ThisTimeLineID, WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), WARNING, XLogCtl, and XLogIsNeeded.

Referenced by perform_base_backup(), and pg_backup_start().

◆ do_pg_backup_stop()

void do_pg_backup_stop ( BackupState state,
bool  waitforarchive 
)

Definition at line 9182 of file xlog.c.

9183{
9184 bool backup_stopped_in_recovery = false;
9185 char histfilepath[MAXPGPATH];
9186 char lastxlogfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
9187 char histfilename[MAXFNAMELEN];
9188 XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
9189 FILE *fp;
9190 int seconds_before_warning;
9191 int waits = 0;
9192 bool reported_waiting = false;
9193
9194 Assert(state != NULL);
9195
9196 backup_stopped_in_recovery = RecoveryInProgress();
9197
9198 /*
9199 * During recovery, we don't need to check WAL level. Because, if WAL
9200 * level is not sufficient, it's impossible to get here during recovery.
9201 */
9202 if (!backup_stopped_in_recovery && !XLogIsNeeded())
9203 ereport(ERROR,
9204 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
9205 errmsg("WAL level not sufficient for making an online backup"),
9206 errhint("\"wal_level\" must be set to \"replica\" or \"logical\" at server start.")));
9207
9208 /*
9209 * OK to update backup counter and session-level lock.
9210 *
9211 * Note that CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() must not occur while updating them,
9212 * otherwise they can be updated inconsistently, which might cause
9213 * do_pg_abort_backup() to fail.
9214 */
9216
9217 /*
9218 * It is expected that each do_pg_backup_start() call is matched by
9219 * exactly one do_pg_backup_stop() call.
9220 */
9223
9224 /*
9225 * Clean up session-level lock.
9226 *
9227 * You might think that WALInsertLockRelease() can be called before
9228 * cleaning up session-level lock because session-level lock doesn't need
9229 * to be protected with WAL insertion lock. But since
9230 * CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS() can occur in it, session-level lock must be
9231 * cleaned up before it.
9232 */
9234
9236
9237 /*
9238 * If we are taking an online backup from the standby, we confirm that the
9239 * standby has not been promoted during the backup.
9240 */
9241 if (state->started_in_recovery && !backup_stopped_in_recovery)
9242 ereport(ERROR,
9243 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
9244 errmsg("the standby was promoted during online backup"),
9245 errhint("This means that the backup being taken is corrupt "
9246 "and should not be used. "
9247 "Try taking another online backup.")));
9248
9249 /*
9250 * During recovery, we don't write an end-of-backup record. We assume that
9251 * pg_control was backed up last and its minimum recovery point can be
9252 * available as the backup end location. Since we don't have an
9253 * end-of-backup record, we use the pg_control value to check whether
9254 * we've reached the end of backup when starting recovery from this
9255 * backup. We have no way of checking if pg_control wasn't backed up last
9256 * however.
9257 *
9258 * We don't force a switch to new WAL file but it is still possible to
9259 * wait for all the required files to be archived if waitforarchive is
9260 * true. This is okay if we use the backup to start a standby and fetch
9261 * the missing WAL using streaming replication. But in the case of an
9262 * archive recovery, a user should set waitforarchive to true and wait for
9263 * them to be archived to ensure that all the required files are
9264 * available.
9265 *
9266 * We return the current minimum recovery point as the backup end
9267 * location. Note that it can be greater than the exact backup end
9268 * location if the minimum recovery point is updated after the backup of
9269 * pg_control. This is harmless for current uses.
9270 *
9271 * XXX currently a backup history file is for informational and debug
9272 * purposes only. It's not essential for an online backup. Furthermore,
9273 * even if it's created, it will not be archived during recovery because
9274 * an archiver is not invoked. So it doesn't seem worthwhile to write a
9275 * backup history file during recovery.
9276 */
9277 if (backup_stopped_in_recovery)
9278 {
9279 XLogRecPtr recptr;
9280
9281 /*
9282 * Check to see if all WAL replayed during online backup contain
9283 * full-page writes.
9284 */
9286 recptr = XLogCtl->lastFpwDisableRecPtr;
9288
9289 if (state->startpoint <= recptr)
9290 ereport(ERROR,
9291 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
9292 errmsg("WAL generated with \"full_page_writes=off\" was replayed "
9293 "during online backup"),
9294 errhint("This means that the backup being taken on the standby "
9295 "is corrupt and should not be used. "
9296 "Enable \"full_page_writes\" and run CHECKPOINT on the primary, "
9297 "and then try an online backup again.")));
9298
9299
9300 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
9301 state->stoppoint = ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint;
9303 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
9304 }
9305 else
9306 {
9307 char *history_file;
9308
9309 /*
9310 * Write the backup-end xlog record
9311 */
9313 XLogRegisterData(&state->startpoint,
9314 sizeof(state->startpoint));
9315 state->stoppoint = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_BACKUP_END);
9316
9317 /*
9318 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
9319 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
9320 */
9321 state->stoptli = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
9322
9323 /*
9324 * Force a switch to a new xlog segment file, so that the backup is
9325 * valid as soon as archiver moves out the current segment file.
9326 */
9327 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
9328
9329 state->stoptime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
9330
9331 /*
9332 * Write the backup history file
9333 */
9334 XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
9335 BackupHistoryFilePath(histfilepath, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
9336 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9337 fp = AllocateFile(histfilepath, "w");
9338 if (!fp)
9339 ereport(ERROR,
9341 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
9342 histfilepath)));
9343
9344 /* Build and save the contents of the backup history file */
9345 history_file = build_backup_content(state, true);
9346 fprintf(fp, "%s", history_file);
9347 pfree(history_file);
9348
9349 if (fflush(fp) || ferror(fp) || FreeFile(fp))
9350 ereport(ERROR,
9352 errmsg("could not write file \"%s\": %m",
9353 histfilepath)));
9354
9355 /*
9356 * Clean out any no-longer-needed history files. As a side effect,
9357 * this will post a .ready file for the newly created history file,
9358 * notifying the archiver that history file may be archived
9359 * immediately.
9360 */
9362 }
9363
9364 /*
9365 * If archiving is enabled, wait for all the required WAL files to be
9366 * archived before returning. If archiving isn't enabled, the required WAL
9367 * needs to be transported via streaming replication (hopefully with
9368 * wal_keep_size set high enough), or some more exotic mechanism like
9369 * polling and copying files from pg_wal with script. We have no knowledge
9370 * of those mechanisms, so it's up to the user to ensure that he gets all
9371 * the required WAL.
9372 *
9373 * We wait until both the last WAL file filled during backup and the
9374 * history file have been archived, and assume that the alphabetic sorting
9375 * property of the WAL files ensures any earlier WAL files are safely
9376 * archived as well.
9377 *
9378 * We wait forever, since archive_command is supposed to work and we
9379 * assume the admin wanted his backup to work completely. If you don't
9380 * wish to wait, then either waitforarchive should be passed in as false,
9381 * or you can set statement_timeout. Also, some notices are issued to
9382 * clue in anyone who might be doing this interactively.
9383 */
9384
9385 if (waitforarchive &&
9386 ((!backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingActive()) ||
9387 (backup_stopped_in_recovery && XLogArchivingAlways())))
9388 {
9389 XLByteToPrevSeg(state->stoppoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
9390 XLogFileName(lastxlogfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
9392
9393 XLByteToSeg(state->startpoint, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
9394 BackupHistoryFileName(histfilename, state->stoptli, _logSegNo,
9395 state->startpoint, wal_segment_size);
9396
9397 seconds_before_warning = 60;
9398 waits = 0;
9399
9400 while (XLogArchiveIsBusy(lastxlogfilename) ||
9401 XLogArchiveIsBusy(histfilename))
9402 {
9404
9405 if (!reported_waiting && waits > 5)
9406 {
9408 (errmsg("base backup done, waiting for required WAL segments to be archived")));
9409 reported_waiting = true;
9410 }
9411
9412 (void) WaitLatch(MyLatch,
9414 1000L,
9415 WAIT_EVENT_BACKUP_WAIT_WAL_ARCHIVE);
9417
9418 if (++waits >= seconds_before_warning)
9419 {
9420 seconds_before_warning *= 2; /* This wraps in >10 years... */
9422 (errmsg("still waiting for all required WAL segments to be archived (%d seconds elapsed)",
9423 waits),
9424 errhint("Check that your \"archive_command\" is executing properly. "
9425 "You can safely cancel this backup, "
9426 "but the database backup will not be usable without all the WAL segments.")));
9427 }
9428 }
9429
9431 (errmsg("all required WAL segments have been archived")));
9432 }
9433 else if (waitforarchive)
9435 (errmsg("WAL archiving is not enabled; you must ensure that all required WAL segments are copied through other means to complete the backup")));
9436}
#define fprintf(file, fmt, msg)
Definition: cubescan.l:21
#define NOTICE
Definition: elog.h:35
int FreeFile(FILE *file)
Definition: fd.c:2823
FILE * AllocateFile(const char *name, const char *mode)
Definition: fd.c:2624
struct Latch * MyLatch
Definition: globals.c:63
void ResetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition: latch.c:374
int WaitLatch(Latch *latch, int wakeEvents, long timeout, uint32 wait_event_info)
Definition: latch.c:172
#define CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS()
Definition: miscadmin.h:123
#define XLOG_BACKUP_END
Definition: pg_control.h:73
#define WL_TIMEOUT
Definition: waiteventset.h:37
#define WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH
Definition: waiteventset.h:39
#define WL_LATCH_SET
Definition: waiteventset.h:34
static void CleanupBackupHistory(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4182
#define XLogArchivingAlways()
Definition: xlog.h:102
static void BackupHistoryFileName(char *fname, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
static void BackupHistoryFilePath(char *path, TimeLineID tli, XLogSegNo logSegNo, XLogRecPtr startpoint, int wal_segsz_bytes)
bool XLogArchiveIsBusy(const char *xlog)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:619
char * build_backup_content(BackupState *state, bool ishistoryfile)
Definition: xlogbackup.c:29

References AllocateFile(), Assert(), BackupHistoryFileName(), BackupHistoryFilePath(), build_backup_content(), CHECK_FOR_INTERRUPTS, CleanupBackupHistory(), ControlFile, ereport, errcode(), errcode_for_file_access(), errhint(), errmsg(), ERROR, fprintf, FreeFile(), XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::Insert, XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, XLogCtlData::lastFpwDisableRecPtr, LW_SHARED, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), MAXFNAMELEN, MAXPGPATH, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, MyLatch, NOTICE, pfree(), RecoveryInProgress(), RequestXLogSwitch(), ResetLatch(), XLogCtlInsert::runningBackups, SESSION_BACKUP_NONE, sessionBackupState, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, WaitLatch(), wal_segment_size, WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), WARNING, WL_EXIT_ON_PM_DEATH, WL_LATCH_SET, WL_TIMEOUT, XLByteToPrevSeg, XLByteToSeg, XLOG_BACKUP_END, XLogArchiveIsBusy(), XLogArchivingActive, XLogArchivingAlways, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogCtl, XLogFileName(), XLogInsert(), XLogIsNeeded, and XLogRegisterData().

Referenced by perform_base_backup(), and pg_backup_stop().

◆ get_backup_status()

SessionBackupState get_backup_status ( void  )

Definition at line 9163 of file xlog.c.

9164{
9165 return sessionBackupState;
9166}

References sessionBackupState.

Referenced by pg_backup_start(), pg_backup_stop(), and SendBaseBackup().

◆ get_sync_bit()

static int get_sync_bit ( int  method)
static

Definition at line 8667 of file xlog.c.

8668{
8669 int o_direct_flag = 0;
8670
8671 /*
8672 * Use O_DIRECT if requested, except in walreceiver process. The WAL
8673 * written by walreceiver is normally read by the startup process soon
8674 * after it's written. Also, walreceiver performs unaligned writes, which
8675 * don't work with O_DIRECT, so it is required for correctness too.
8676 */
8678 o_direct_flag = PG_O_DIRECT;
8679
8680 /* If fsync is disabled, never open in sync mode */
8681 if (!enableFsync)
8682 return o_direct_flag;
8683
8684 switch (method)
8685 {
8686 /*
8687 * enum values for all sync options are defined even if they are
8688 * not supported on the current platform. But if not, they are
8689 * not included in the enum option array, and therefore will never
8690 * be seen here.
8691 */
8695 return o_direct_flag;
8696#ifdef O_SYNC
8698 return O_SYNC | o_direct_flag;
8699#endif
8700#ifdef O_DSYNC
8702 return O_DSYNC | o_direct_flag;
8703#endif
8704 default:
8705 /* can't happen (unless we are out of sync with option array) */
8706 elog(ERROR, "unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", method);
8707 return 0; /* silence warning */
8708 }
8709}
int io_direct_flags
Definition: fd.c:168
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL
Definition: fd.h:55
#define PG_O_DIRECT
Definition: fd.h:112
bool enableFsync
Definition: globals.c:129
#define AmWalReceiverProcess()
Definition: miscadmin.h:391
#define O_DSYNC
Definition: win32_port.h:346
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN
Definition: xlog.h:26
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC
Definition: xlog.h:25
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
Definition: xlog.h:27
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC
Definition: xlog.h:28
@ WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC
Definition: xlog.h:24

References AmWalReceiverProcess, elog, enableFsync, ERROR, io_direct_flags, IO_DIRECT_WAL, O_DSYNC, PG_O_DIRECT, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, and WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC.

Referenced by assign_wal_sync_method(), XLogFileInit(), XLogFileInitInternal(), and XLogFileOpen().

◆ GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby()

WalLevel GetActiveWalLevelOnStandby ( void  )

Definition at line 4917 of file xlog.c.

4918{
4919 return ControlFile->wal_level;
4920}

References ControlFile, and ControlFileData::wal_level.

Referenced by CheckLogicalDecodingRequirements().

◆ GetDefaultCharSignedness()

bool GetDefaultCharSignedness ( void  )

Definition at line 4645 of file xlog.c.

4646{
4648}
bool default_char_signedness
Definition: pg_control.h:230

References ControlFile, and ControlFileData::default_char_signedness.

Referenced by CMPTRGM_CHOOSE().

◆ GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel()

XLogRecPtr GetFakeLSNForUnloggedRel ( void  )

Definition at line 4660 of file xlog.c.

4661{
4663}
static uint64 pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, int64 add_)
Definition: atomics.h:532

References pg_atomic_fetch_add_u64(), XLogCtlData::unloggedLSN, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by gistGetFakeLSN().

◆ GetFlushRecPtr()

XLogRecPtr GetFlushRecPtr ( TimeLineID insertTLI)

◆ GetFullPageWriteInfo()

void GetFullPageWriteInfo ( XLogRecPtr RedoRecPtr_p,
bool *  doPageWrites_p 
)

Definition at line 6537 of file xlog.c.

6538{
6539 *RedoRecPtr_p = RedoRecPtr;
6540 *doPageWrites_p = doPageWrites;
6541}
static bool doPageWrites
Definition: xlog.c:288

References doPageWrites, and RedoRecPtr.

Referenced by XLogCheckBufferNeedsBackup(), and XLogInsert().

◆ GetInsertRecPtr()

XLogRecPtr GetInsertRecPtr ( void  )

◆ GetLastImportantRecPtr()

XLogRecPtr GetLastImportantRecPtr ( void  )

Definition at line 6626 of file xlog.c.

6627{
6629 int i;
6630
6631 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
6632 {
6633 XLogRecPtr last_important;
6634
6635 /*
6636 * Need to take a lock to prevent torn reads of the LSN, which are
6637 * possible on some of the supported platforms. WAL insert locks only
6638 * support exclusive mode, so we have to use that.
6639 */
6641 last_important = WALInsertLocks[i].l.lastImportantAt;
6642 LWLockRelease(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock);
6643
6644 if (res < last_important)
6645 res = last_important;
6646 }
6647
6648 return res;
6649}
int i
Definition: isn.c:77
XLogRecPtr lastImportantAt
Definition: xlog.c:373
WALInsertLock l
Definition: xlog.c:385
static WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition: xlog.c:570
#define NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS
Definition: xlog.c:152

References i, InvalidXLogRecPtr, WALInsertLockPadded::l, WALInsertLock::lastImportantAt, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, and WALInsertLocks.

Referenced by BackgroundWriterMain(), CheckArchiveTimeout(), and CreateCheckPoint().

◆ GetLastSegSwitchData()

pg_time_t GetLastSegSwitchData ( XLogRecPtr lastSwitchLSN)

Definition at line 6655 of file xlog.c.

6656{
6657 pg_time_t result;
6658
6659 /* Need WALWriteLock, but shared lock is sufficient */
6660 LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_SHARED);
6661 result = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime;
6662 *lastSwitchLSN = XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN;
6663 LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
6664
6665 return result;
6666}
pg_time_t lastSegSwitchTime
Definition: xlog.c:468
XLogRecPtr lastSegSwitchLSN
Definition: xlog.c:469

References XLogCtlData::lastSegSwitchLSN, XLogCtlData::lastSegSwitchTime, LW_SHARED, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), and XLogCtl.

Referenced by CheckArchiveTimeout().

◆ GetMockAuthenticationNonce()

char * GetMockAuthenticationNonce ( void  )

Definition at line 4621 of file xlog.c.

4622{
4623 Assert(ControlFile != NULL);
4625}
char mock_authentication_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN]
Definition: pg_control.h:237

References Assert(), ControlFile, and ControlFileData::mock_authentication_nonce.

Referenced by scram_mock_salt().

◆ GetOldestRestartPoint()

void GetOldestRestartPoint ( XLogRecPtr oldrecptr,
TimeLineID oldtli 
)

◆ GetRecoveryState()

RecoveryState GetRecoveryState ( void  )

Definition at line 6440 of file xlog.c.

6441{
6442 RecoveryState retval;
6443
6445 retval = XLogCtl->SharedRecoveryState;
6447
6448 return retval;
6449}
RecoveryState
Definition: xlog.h:90

References XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::SharedRecoveryState, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by XLogArchiveCheckDone().

◆ GetRedoRecPtr()

XLogRecPtr GetRedoRecPtr ( void  )

Definition at line 6507 of file xlog.c.

6508{
6509 XLogRecPtr ptr;
6510
6511 /*
6512 * The possibly not up-to-date copy in XlogCtl is enough. Even if we
6513 * grabbed a WAL insertion lock to read the authoritative value in
6514 * Insert->RedoRecPtr, someone might update it just after we've released
6515 * the lock.
6516 */
6518 ptr = XLogCtl->RedoRecPtr;
6520
6521 if (RedoRecPtr < ptr)
6522 RedoRecPtr = ptr;
6523
6524 return RedoRecPtr;
6525}

References XLogCtlData::info_lck, RedoRecPtr, XLogCtlData::RedoRecPtr, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by CheckPointLogicalRewriteHeap(), CheckPointSnapBuild(), MaybeRemoveOldWalSummaries(), nextval_internal(), ReplicationSlotReserveWal(), smgr_bulk_finish(), smgr_bulk_start_smgr(), XLogPageRead(), XLogSaveBufferForHint(), and XLogWrite().

◆ GetSystemIdentifier()

◆ GetWALAvailability()

WALAvailability GetWALAvailability ( XLogRecPtr  targetLSN)

Definition at line 7935 of file xlog.c.

7936{
7937 XLogRecPtr currpos; /* current write LSN */
7938 XLogSegNo currSeg; /* segid of currpos */
7939 XLogSegNo targetSeg; /* segid of targetLSN */
7940 XLogSegNo oldestSeg; /* actual oldest segid */
7941 XLogSegNo oldestSegMaxWalSize; /* oldest segid kept by max_wal_size */
7942 XLogSegNo oldestSlotSeg; /* oldest segid kept by slot */
7943 uint64 keepSegs;
7944
7945 /*
7946 * slot does not reserve WAL. Either deactivated, or has never been active
7947 */
7948 if (!XLogRecPtrIsValid(targetLSN))
7949 return WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN;
7950
7951 /*
7952 * Calculate the oldest segment currently reserved by all slots,
7953 * considering wal_keep_size and max_slot_wal_keep_size. Initialize
7954 * oldestSlotSeg to the current segment.
7955 */
7956 currpos = GetXLogWriteRecPtr();
7957 XLByteToSeg(currpos, oldestSlotSeg, wal_segment_size);
7958 KeepLogSeg(currpos, &oldestSlotSeg);
7959
7960 /*
7961 * Find the oldest extant segment file. We get 1 until checkpoint removes
7962 * the first WAL segment file since startup, which causes the status being
7963 * wrong under certain abnormal conditions but that doesn't actually harm.
7964 */
7965 oldestSeg = XLogGetLastRemovedSegno() + 1;
7966
7967 /* calculate oldest segment by max_wal_size */
7968 XLByteToSeg(currpos, currSeg, wal_segment_size);
7970
7971 if (currSeg > keepSegs)
7972 oldestSegMaxWalSize = currSeg - keepSegs;
7973 else
7974 oldestSegMaxWalSize = 1;
7975
7976 /* the segment we care about */
7977 XLByteToSeg(targetLSN, targetSeg, wal_segment_size);
7978
7979 /*
7980 * No point in returning reserved or extended status values if the
7981 * targetSeg is known to be lost.
7982 */
7983 if (targetSeg >= oldestSlotSeg)
7984 {
7985 /* show "reserved" when targetSeg is within max_wal_size */
7986 if (targetSeg >= oldestSegMaxWalSize)
7987 return WALAVAIL_RESERVED;
7988
7989 /* being retained by slots exceeding max_wal_size */
7990 return WALAVAIL_EXTENDED;
7991 }
7992
7993 /* WAL segments are no longer retained but haven't been removed yet */
7994 if (targetSeg >= oldestSeg)
7995 return WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED;
7996
7997 /* Definitely lost */
7998 return WALAVAIL_REMOVED;
7999}
XLogSegNo XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(void)
Definition: xlog.c:3779
XLogRecPtr GetXLogWriteRecPtr(void)
Definition: xlog.c:9513
@ WALAVAIL_REMOVED
Definition: xlog.h:194
@ WALAVAIL_RESERVED
Definition: xlog.h:190
@ WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED
Definition: xlog.h:193
@ WALAVAIL_EXTENDED
Definition: xlog.h:191
@ WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN
Definition: xlog.h:189

References ConvertToXSegs, GetXLogWriteRecPtr(), KeepLogSeg(), max_wal_size_mb, wal_segment_size, WALAVAIL_EXTENDED, WALAVAIL_INVALID_LSN, WALAVAIL_REMOVED, WALAVAIL_RESERVED, WALAVAIL_UNRESERVED, XLByteToSeg, XLogGetLastRemovedSegno(), and XLogRecPtrIsValid.

Referenced by pg_get_replication_slots().

◆ GetWALInsertionTimeLine()

TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLine ( void  )

◆ GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet()

TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLineIfSet ( void  )

Definition at line 6606 of file xlog.c.

6607{
6608 TimeLineID insertTLI;
6609
6611 insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
6613
6614 return insertTLI;
6615}

References XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by GetLatestLSN().

◆ GetXLogBuffer()

static char * GetXLogBuffer ( XLogRecPtr  ptr,
TimeLineID  tli 
)
static

Definition at line 1638 of file xlog.c.

1639{
1640 int idx;
1641 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1642 static uint64 cachedPage = 0;
1643 static char *cachedPos = NULL;
1644 XLogRecPtr expectedEndPtr;
1645
1646 /*
1647 * Fast path for the common case that we need to access again the same
1648 * page as last time.
1649 */
1650 if (ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ == cachedPage)
1651 {
1652 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
1653 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1654 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1655 }
1656
1657 /*
1658 * The XLog buffer cache is organized so that a page is always loaded to a
1659 * particular buffer. That way we can easily calculate the buffer a given
1660 * page must be loaded into, from the XLogRecPtr alone.
1661 */
1662 idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(ptr);
1663
1664 /*
1665 * See what page is loaded in the buffer at the moment. It could be the
1666 * page we're looking for, or something older. It can't be anything newer
1667 * - that would imply the page we're looking for has already been written
1668 * out to disk and evicted, and the caller is responsible for making sure
1669 * that doesn't happen.
1670 *
1671 * We don't hold a lock while we read the value. If someone is just about
1672 * to initialize or has just initialized the page, it's possible that we
1673 * get InvalidXLogRecPtr. That's ok, we'll grab the mapping lock (in
1674 * AdvanceXLInsertBuffer) and retry if we see anything other than the page
1675 * we're looking for.
1676 */
1677 expectedEndPtr = ptr;
1678 expectedEndPtr += XLOG_BLCKSZ - ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1679
1681 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1682 {
1683 XLogRecPtr initializedUpto;
1684
1685 /*
1686 * Before calling AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), which can block, let others
1687 * know how far we're finished with inserting the record.
1688 *
1689 * NB: If 'ptr' points to just after the page header, advertise a
1690 * position at the beginning of the page rather than 'ptr' itself. If
1691 * there are no other insertions running, someone might try to flush
1692 * up to our advertised location. If we advertised a position after
1693 * the page header, someone might try to flush the page header, even
1694 * though page might actually not be initialized yet. As the first
1695 * inserter on the page, we are effectively responsible for making
1696 * sure that it's initialized, before we let insertingAt to move past
1697 * the page header.
1698 */
1699 if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogShortPHD &&
1700 XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) > XLOG_BLCKSZ)
1701 initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1702 else if (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ == SizeOfXLogLongPHD &&
1703 XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) < XLOG_BLCKSZ)
1704 initializedUpto = ptr - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1705 else
1706 initializedUpto = ptr;
1707
1708 WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(initializedUpto);
1709
1710 AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(ptr, tli, false);
1712
1713 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1714 elog(PANIC, "could not find WAL buffer for %X/%08X",
1715 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(ptr));
1716 }
1717 else
1718 {
1719 /*
1720 * Make sure the initialization of the page is visible to us, and
1721 * won't arrive later to overwrite the WAL data we write on the page.
1722 */
1724 }
1725
1726 /*
1727 * Found the buffer holding this page. Return a pointer to the right
1728 * offset within the page.
1729 */
1730 cachedPage = ptr / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1731 cachedPos = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1732
1733 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_magic == XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC);
1734 Assert(((XLogPageHeader) cachedPos)->xlp_pageaddr == ptr - (ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ));
1735
1736 return cachedPos + ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1737}
Datum idx(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition: _int_op.c:262
#define pg_memory_barrier()
Definition: atomics.h:141
static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(XLogRecPtr insertingAt)
Definition: xlog.c:1477
static void AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(XLogRecPtr upto, TimeLineID tli, bool opportunistic)
Definition: xlog.c:1991

References AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), Assert(), elog, idx(), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, XLogCtlData::pages, PANIC, pg_atomic_read_u64(), pg_memory_barrier, SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, wal_segment_size, WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt(), XLogCtlData::xlblocks, XLOG_PAGE_MAGIC, XLogCtl, XLogRecPtrToBufIdx, and XLogSegmentOffset.

Referenced by CopyXLogRecordToWAL(), and CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord().

◆ GetXLogInsertRecPtr()

XLogRecPtr GetXLogInsertRecPtr ( void  )

Definition at line 9497 of file xlog.c.

9498{
9500 uint64 current_bytepos;
9501
9502 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9503 current_bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
9504 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
9505
9506 return XLogBytePosToRecPtr(current_bytepos);
9507}

References XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, XLogBytePosToRecPtr(), and XLogCtl.

Referenced by CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(), gistGetFakeLSN(), logical_begin_heap_rewrite(), pg_current_wal_insert_lsn(), and ReplicationSlotReserveWal().

◆ GetXLogWriteRecPtr()

◆ InitControlFile()

static void InitControlFile ( uint64  sysidentifier,
uint32  data_checksum_version 
)
static

Definition at line 4225 of file xlog.c.

4226{
4227 char mock_auth_nonce[MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN];
4228
4229 /*
4230 * Generate a random nonce. This is used for authentication requests that
4231 * will fail because the user does not exist. The nonce is used to create
4232 * a genuine-looking password challenge for the non-existent user, in lieu
4233 * of an actual stored password.
4234 */
4235 if (!pg_strong_random(mock_auth_nonce, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN))
4236 ereport(PANIC,
4237 (errcode(ERRCODE_INTERNAL_ERROR),
4238 errmsg("could not generate secret authorization token")));
4239
4240 memset(ControlFile, 0, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4241 /* Initialize pg_control status fields */
4242 ControlFile->system_identifier = sysidentifier;
4246
4247 /* Set important parameter values for use when replaying WAL */
4256 ControlFile->data_checksum_version = data_checksum_version;
4257}
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition: commit_ts.c:109
#define MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN
Definition: pg_control.h:28
bool pg_strong_random(void *buf, size_t len)
bool track_commit_timestamp
Definition: pg_control.h:185
bool wal_log_hints
Definition: xlog.c:125
#define FirstNormalUnloggedLSN
Definition: xlogdefs.h:37

References ControlFile, ControlFileData::data_checksum_version, DB_SHUTDOWNED, ereport, errcode(), errmsg(), FirstNormalUnloggedLSN, max_locks_per_xact, ControlFileData::max_locks_per_xact, max_prepared_xacts, ControlFileData::max_prepared_xacts, max_wal_senders, ControlFileData::max_wal_senders, max_worker_processes, ControlFileData::max_worker_processes, MaxConnections, ControlFileData::MaxConnections, MOCK_AUTH_NONCE_LEN, ControlFileData::mock_authentication_nonce, PANIC, pg_strong_random(), ControlFileData::state, ControlFileData::system_identifier, track_commit_timestamp, ControlFileData::track_commit_timestamp, ControlFileData::unloggedLSN, wal_level, ControlFileData::wal_level, wal_log_hints, and ControlFileData::wal_log_hints.

Referenced by BootStrapXLOG().

◆ InitializeWalConsistencyChecking()

void InitializeWalConsistencyChecking ( void  )

Definition at line 4842 of file xlog.c.

4843{
4845
4847 {
4848 struct config_generic *guc;
4849
4850 guc = find_option("wal_consistency_checking", false, false, ERROR);
4851
4853
4854 set_config_option_ext("wal_consistency_checking",
4856 guc->scontext, guc->source, guc->srole,
4857 GUC_ACTION_SET, true, ERROR, false);
4858
4859 /* checking should not be deferred again */
4861 }
4862}
int set_config_option_ext(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source, Oid srole, GucAction action, bool changeVal, int elevel, bool is_reload)
Definition: guc.c:3256
struct config_generic * find_option(const char *name, bool create_placeholders, bool skip_errors, int elevel)
Definition: guc.c:1113
@ GUC_ACTION_SET
Definition: guc.h:203
GucContext scontext
Definition: guc_tables.h:263
GucSource source
Definition: guc_tables.h:261
char * wal_consistency_checking_string
Definition: xlog.c:127

References Assert(), check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred, ERROR, find_option(), GUC_ACTION_SET, process_shared_preload_libraries_done, config_generic::scontext, set_config_option_ext(), config_generic::source, config_generic::srole, and wal_consistency_checking_string.

Referenced by PostgresSingleUserMain(), and PostmasterMain().

◆ InstallXLogFileSegment()

static bool InstallXLogFileSegment ( XLogSegNo segno,
char *  tmppath,
bool  find_free,
XLogSegNo  max_segno,
TimeLineID  tli 
)
static

Definition at line 3584 of file xlog.c.

3586{
3587 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3588 struct stat stat_buf;
3589
3590 Assert(tli != 0);
3591
3592 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3593
3594 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
3596 {
3597 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
3598 return false;
3599 }
3600
3601 if (!find_free)
3602 {
3603 /* Force installation: get rid of any pre-existing segment file */
3604 durable_unlink(path, DEBUG1);
3605 }
3606 else
3607 {
3608 /* Find a free slot to put it in */
3609 while (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
3610 {
3611 if ((*segno) >= max_segno)
3612 {
3613 /* Failed to find a free slot within specified range */
3614 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
3615 return false;
3616 }
3617 (*segno)++;
3618 XLogFilePath(path, tli, *segno, wal_segment_size);
3619 }
3620 }
3621
3622 Assert(access(path, F_OK) != 0 && errno == ENOENT);
3623 if (durable_rename(tmppath, path, LOG) != 0)
3624 {
3625 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
3626 /* durable_rename already emitted log message */
3627 return false;
3628 }
3629
3630 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
3631
3632 return true;
3633}
int durable_unlink(const char *fname, int elevel)
Definition: fd.c:869
short access
Definition: preproc-type.c:36
bool InstallXLogFileSegmentActive
Definition: xlog.c:527
#define stat
Definition: win32_port.h:274

References Assert(), DEBUG1, durable_rename(), durable_unlink(), XLogCtlData::InstallXLogFileSegmentActive, LOG, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), MAXPGPATH, stat, wal_segment_size, XLogCtl, and XLogFilePath().

Referenced by RemoveXlogFile(), XLogFileCopy(), and XLogFileInitInternal().

◆ IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive()

bool IsInstallXLogFileSegmentActive ( void  )

Definition at line 9562 of file xlog.c.

9563{
9564 bool result;
9565
9566 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED);
9568 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
9569
9570 return result;
9571}

References XLogCtlData::InstallXLogFileSegmentActive, LW_SHARED, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), and XLogCtl.

Referenced by XLogFileRead().

◆ issue_xlog_fsync()

void issue_xlog_fsync ( int  fd,
XLogSegNo  segno,
TimeLineID  tli 
)

Definition at line 8757 of file xlog.c.

8758{
8759 char *msg = NULL;
8761
8762 Assert(tli != 0);
8763
8764 /*
8765 * Quick exit if fsync is disabled or write() has already synced the WAL
8766 * file.
8767 */
8768 if (!enableFsync ||
8771 return;
8772
8773 /*
8774 * Measure I/O timing to sync the WAL file for pg_stat_io.
8775 */
8777
8778 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_SYNC);
8779 switch (wal_sync_method)
8780 {
8782 if (pg_fsync_no_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8783 msg = _("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m");
8784 break;
8785#ifdef HAVE_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH
8787 if (pg_fsync_writethrough(fd) != 0)
8788 msg = _("could not fsync write-through file \"%s\": %m");
8789 break;
8790#endif
8792 if (pg_fdatasync(fd) != 0)
8793 msg = _("could not fdatasync file \"%s\": %m");
8794 break;
8797 /* not reachable */
8798 Assert(false);
8799 break;
8800 default:
8801 ereport(PANIC,
8802 errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
8803 errmsg_internal("unrecognized \"wal_sync_method\": %d", wal_sync_method));
8804 break;
8805 }
8806
8807 /* PANIC if failed to fsync */
8808 if (msg)
8809 {
8810 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
8811 int save_errno = errno;
8812
8813 XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
8814 errno = save_errno;
8815 ereport(PANIC,
8817 errmsg(msg, xlogfname)));
8818 }
8819
8821
8823 start, 1, 0);
8824}
#define _(x)
Definition: elog.c:91
int pg_fsync_no_writethrough(int fd)
Definition: fd.c:438
int pg_fdatasync(int fd)
Definition: fd.c:477
int pg_fsync_writethrough(int fd)
Definition: fd.c:458
return str start
@ IOOBJECT_WAL
Definition: pgstat.h:279
@ IOCONTEXT_NORMAL
Definition: pgstat.h:289
@ IOOP_FSYNC
Definition: pgstat.h:308
instr_time pgstat_prepare_io_time(bool track_io_guc)
Definition: pgstat_io.c:91
void pgstat_count_io_op_time(IOObject io_object, IOContext io_context, IOOp io_op, instr_time start_time, uint32 cnt, uint64 bytes)
Definition: pgstat_io.c:122
static int fd(const char *x, int i)
Definition: preproc-init.c:105
bool track_wal_io_timing
Definition: xlog.c:139

References _, Assert(), enableFsync, ereport, errcode(), errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), errmsg_internal(), fd(), IOCONTEXT_NORMAL, IOOBJECT_WAL, IOOP_FSYNC, MAXFNAMELEN, PANIC, pg_fdatasync(), pg_fsync_no_writethrough(), pg_fsync_writethrough(), pgstat_count_io_op_time(), pgstat_prepare_io_time(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), start, track_wal_io_timing, wal_segment_size, wal_sync_method, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC_WRITETHROUGH, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, and XLogFileName().

Referenced by XLogWalRcvFlush(), and XLogWrite().

◆ KeepLogSeg()

static void KeepLogSeg ( XLogRecPtr  recptr,
XLogSegNo logSegNo 
)
static

Definition at line 8019 of file xlog.c.

8020{
8021 XLogSegNo currSegNo;
8022 XLogSegNo segno;
8023 XLogRecPtr keep;
8024
8025 XLByteToSeg(recptr, currSegNo, wal_segment_size);
8026 segno = currSegNo;
8027
8028 /* Calculate how many segments are kept by slots. */
8030 if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(keep) && keep < recptr)
8031 {
8032 XLByteToSeg(keep, segno, wal_segment_size);
8033
8034 /*
8035 * Account for max_slot_wal_keep_size to avoid keeping more than
8036 * configured. However, don't do that during a binary upgrade: if
8037 * slots were to be invalidated because of this, it would not be
8038 * possible to preserve logical ones during the upgrade.
8039 */
8041 {
8042 uint64 slot_keep_segs;
8043
8044 slot_keep_segs =
8046
8047 if (currSegNo - segno > slot_keep_segs)
8048 segno = currSegNo - slot_keep_segs;
8049 }
8050 }
8051
8052 /*
8053 * If WAL summarization is in use, don't remove WAL that has yet to be
8054 * summarized.
8055 */
8056 keep = GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(NULL, NULL);
8057 if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(keep))
8058 {
8059 XLogSegNo unsummarized_segno;
8060
8061 XLByteToSeg(keep, unsummarized_segno, wal_segment_size);
8062 if (unsummarized_segno < segno)
8063 segno = unsummarized_segno;
8064 }
8065
8066 /* but, keep at least wal_keep_size if that's set */
8067 if (wal_keep_size_mb > 0)
8068 {
8069 uint64 keep_segs;
8070
8072 if (currSegNo - segno < keep_segs)
8073 {
8074 /* avoid underflow, don't go below 1 */
8075 if (currSegNo <= keep_segs)
8076 segno = 1;
8077 else
8078 segno = currSegNo - keep_segs;
8079 }
8080 }
8081
8082 /* don't delete WAL segments newer than the calculated segment */
8083 if (segno < *logSegNo)
8084 *logSegNo = segno;
8085}
bool IsBinaryUpgrade
Definition: globals.c:121
XLogRecPtr GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(TimeLineID *tli, bool *lsn_is_exact)
int wal_keep_size_mb
Definition: xlog.c:118
static XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(void)
Definition: xlog.c:2682
int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb
Definition: xlog.c:137

References ConvertToXSegs, GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(), IsBinaryUpgrade, max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb, wal_keep_size_mb, wal_segment_size, XLByteToSeg, XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN(), and XLogRecPtrIsValid.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), CreateRestartPoint(), and GetWALAvailability().

◆ LocalProcessControlFile()

void LocalProcessControlFile ( bool  reset)

Definition at line 4904 of file xlog.c.

4905{
4906 Assert(reset || ControlFile == NULL);
4909}
void reset(void)
Definition: sql-declare.c:600

References Assert(), ControlFile, palloc_object, ReadControlFile(), and reset().

Referenced by PostgresSingleUserMain(), PostmasterMain(), and PostmasterStateMachine().

◆ LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed()

static int LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed ( void  )
static

Definition at line 6492 of file xlog.c.

6493{
6494 int oldXLogAllowed = LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
6495
6497
6498 return oldXLogAllowed;
6499}

References LocalXLogInsertAllowed.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), and StartupXLOG().

◆ LogCheckpointEnd()

static void LogCheckpointEnd ( bool  restartpoint)
static

Definition at line 6751 of file xlog.c.

6752{
6753 long write_msecs,
6754 sync_msecs,
6755 total_msecs,
6756 longest_msecs,
6757 average_msecs;
6758 uint64 average_sync_time;
6759
6761
6764
6767
6768 /* Accumulate checkpoint timing summary data, in milliseconds. */
6769 PendingCheckpointerStats.write_time += write_msecs;
6770 PendingCheckpointerStats.sync_time += sync_msecs;
6771
6772 /*
6773 * All of the published timing statistics are accounted for. Only
6774 * continue if a log message is to be written.
6775 */
6776 if (!log_checkpoints)
6777 return;
6778
6781
6782 /*
6783 * Timing values returned from CheckpointStats are in microseconds.
6784 * Convert to milliseconds for consistent printing.
6785 */
6786 longest_msecs = (long) ((CheckpointStats.ckpt_longest_sync + 999) / 1000);
6787
6788 average_sync_time = 0;
6790 average_sync_time = CheckpointStats.ckpt_agg_sync_time /
6792 average_msecs = (long) ((average_sync_time + 999) / 1000);
6793
6794 /*
6795 * ControlFileLock is not required to see ControlFile->checkPoint and
6796 * ->checkPointCopy here as we are the only updator of those variables at
6797 * this moment.
6798 */
6799 if (restartpoint)
6800 ereport(LOG,
6801 (errmsg("restartpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6802 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6803 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6804 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6805 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6806 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6813 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6814 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6815 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6817 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6818 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6819 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6820 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6823 else
6824 ereport(LOG,
6825 (errmsg("checkpoint complete: wrote %d buffers (%.1f%%), "
6826 "wrote %d SLRU buffers; %d WAL file(s) added, "
6827 "%d removed, %d recycled; write=%ld.%03d s, "
6828 "sync=%ld.%03d s, total=%ld.%03d s; sync files=%d, "
6829 "longest=%ld.%03d s, average=%ld.%03d s; distance=%d kB, "
6830 "estimate=%d kB; lsn=%X/%08X, redo lsn=%X/%08X",
6837 write_msecs / 1000, (int) (write_msecs % 1000),
6838 sync_msecs / 1000, (int) (sync_msecs % 1000),
6839 total_msecs / 1000, (int) (total_msecs % 1000),
6841 longest_msecs / 1000, (int) (longest_msecs % 1000),
6842 average_msecs / 1000, (int) (average_msecs % 1000),
6843 (int) (PrevCheckPointDistance / 1024.0),
6844 (int) (CheckPointDistanceEstimate / 1024.0),
6847}
long TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time)
Definition: timestamp.c:1757
PgStat_CheckpointerStats PendingCheckpointerStats
uint64 ckpt_agg_sync_time
Definition: xlog.h:176
uint64 ckpt_longest_sync
Definition: xlog.h:175
TimestampTz ckpt_end_t
Definition: xlog.h:165
int ckpt_slru_written
Definition: xlog.h:168
int ckpt_sync_rels
Definition: xlog.h:174
PgStat_Counter sync_time
Definition: pgstat.h:265
PgStat_Counter write_time
Definition: pgstat.h:264
static double CheckPointDistanceEstimate
Definition: xlog.c:161
static double PrevCheckPointDistance
Definition: xlog.c:162

References ControlFileData::checkPoint, ControlFileData::checkPointCopy, CheckPointDistanceEstimate, CheckpointStats, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_agg_sync_time, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_bufs_written, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_end_t, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_longest_sync, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_added, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_recycled, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_removed, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_slru_written, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_start_t, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_sync_end_t, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_sync_rels, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_sync_t, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_write_t, ControlFile, ereport, errmsg(), GetCurrentTimestamp(), LOG, log_checkpoints, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, NBuffers, PendingCheckpointerStats, PrevCheckPointDistance, CheckPoint::redo, PgStat_CheckpointerStats::sync_time, TimestampDifferenceMilliseconds(), and PgStat_CheckpointerStats::write_time.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), and CreateRestartPoint().

◆ LogCheckpointStart()

static void LogCheckpointStart ( int  flags,
bool  restartpoint 
)
static

Definition at line 6719 of file xlog.c.

6720{
6721 if (restartpoint)
6722 ereport(LOG,
6723 /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
6724 (errmsg("restartpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
6725 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
6726 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
6727 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
6728 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
6729 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
6730 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
6731 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
6732 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "")));
6733 else
6734 ereport(LOG,
6735 /* translator: the placeholders show checkpoint options */
6736 (errmsg("checkpoint starting:%s%s%s%s%s%s%s%s",
6737 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? " shutdown" : "",
6738 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? " end-of-recovery" : "",
6739 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FAST) ? " fast" : "",
6740 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FORCE) ? " force" : "",
6741 (flags & CHECKPOINT_WAIT) ? " wait" : "",
6742 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG) ? " wal" : "",
6743 (flags & CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME) ? " time" : "",
6744 (flags & CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED) ? " flush-unlogged" : "")));
6745}
#define CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED
Definition: xlog.h:143
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG
Definition: xlog.h:148
#define CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME
Definition: xlog.h:149

References CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_TIME, CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG, CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY, CHECKPOINT_FAST, CHECKPOINT_FLUSH_UNLOGGED, CHECKPOINT_FORCE, CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN, CHECKPOINT_WAIT, ereport, errmsg(), and LOG.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), and CreateRestartPoint().

◆ PerformRecoveryXLogAction()

static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction ( void  )
static

Definition at line 6354 of file xlog.c.

6355{
6356 bool promoted = false;
6357
6358 /*
6359 * Perform a checkpoint to update all our recovery activity to disk.
6360 *
6361 * Note that we write a shutdown checkpoint rather than an on-line one.
6362 * This is not particularly critical, but since we may be assigning a new
6363 * TLI, using a shutdown checkpoint allows us to have the rule that TLI
6364 * only changes in shutdown checkpoints, which allows some extra error
6365 * checking in xlog_redo.
6366 *
6367 * In promotion, only create a lightweight end-of-recovery record instead
6368 * of a full checkpoint. A checkpoint is requested later, after we're
6369 * fully out of recovery mode and already accepting queries.
6370 */
6373 {
6374 promoted = true;
6375
6376 /*
6377 * Insert a special WAL record to mark the end of recovery, since we
6378 * aren't doing a checkpoint. That means that the checkpointer process
6379 * may likely be in the middle of a time-smoothed restartpoint and
6380 * could continue to be for minutes after this. That sounds strange,
6381 * but the effect is roughly the same and it would be stranger to try
6382 * to come out of the restartpoint and then checkpoint. We request a
6383 * checkpoint later anyway, just for safety.
6384 */
6386 }
6387 else
6388 {
6392 }
6393
6394 return promoted;
6395}
static void CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(void)
Definition: xlog.c:7442
bool PromoteIsTriggered(void)

References ArchiveRecoveryRequested, CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY, CHECKPOINT_FAST, CHECKPOINT_WAIT, CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(), IsUnderPostmaster, PromoteIsTriggered(), and RequestCheckpoint().

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ PreallocXlogFiles()

static void PreallocXlogFiles ( XLogRecPtr  endptr,
TimeLineID  tli 
)
static

Definition at line 3711 of file xlog.c.

3712{
3713 XLogSegNo _logSegNo;
3714 int lf;
3715 bool added;
3716 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3717 uint64 offset;
3718
3720 return; /* unlocked check says no */
3721
3722 XLByteToPrevSeg(endptr, _logSegNo, wal_segment_size);
3723 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(endptr - 1, wal_segment_size);
3724 if (offset >= (uint32) (0.75 * wal_segment_size))
3725 {
3726 _logSegNo++;
3727 lf = XLogFileInitInternal(_logSegNo, tli, &added, path);
3728 if (lf >= 0)
3729 close(lf);
3730 if (added)
3732 }
3733}
static int XLogFileInitInternal(XLogSegNo logsegno, TimeLineID logtli, bool *added, char *path)
Definition: xlog.c:3213

References CheckpointStats, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_added, close, XLogCtlData::InstallXLogFileSegmentActive, MAXPGPATH, wal_segment_size, XLByteToPrevSeg, XLogCtl, XLogFileInitInternal(), and XLogSegmentOffset.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), CreateRestartPoint(), and StartupXLOG().

◆ ReachedEndOfBackup()

void ReachedEndOfBackup ( XLogRecPtr  EndRecPtr,
TimeLineID  tli 
)

Definition at line 6317 of file xlog.c.

6318{
6319 /*
6320 * We have reached the end of base backup, as indicated by pg_control. The
6321 * data on disk is now consistent (unless minRecoveryPoint is further
6322 * ahead, which can happen if we crashed during previous recovery). Reset
6323 * backupStartPoint and backupEndPoint, and update minRecoveryPoint to
6324 * make sure we don't allow starting up at an earlier point even if
6325 * recovery is stopped and restarted soon after this.
6326 */
6327 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
6328
6329 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6330 {
6331 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6333 }
6334
6339
6340 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
6341}
XLogRecPtr backupStartPoint
Definition: pg_control.h:170
bool backupEndRequired
Definition: pg_control.h:172
XLogRecPtr backupEndPoint
Definition: pg_control.h:171

References ControlFileData::backupEndPoint, ControlFileData::backupEndRequired, ControlFileData::backupStartPoint, ControlFile, InvalidXLogRecPtr, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, and UpdateControlFile().

Referenced by CheckRecoveryConsistency().

◆ ReadControlFile()

static void ReadControlFile ( void  )
static

Definition at line 4370 of file xlog.c.

4371{
4372 pg_crc32c crc;
4373 int fd;
4374 char wal_segsz_str[20];
4375 int r;
4376
4377 /*
4378 * Read data...
4379 */
4381 O_RDWR | PG_BINARY);
4382 if (fd < 0)
4383 ereport(PANIC,
4385 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m",
4387
4388 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_READ);
4389 r = read(fd, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4390 if (r != sizeof(ControlFileData))
4391 {
4392 if (r < 0)
4393 ereport(PANIC,
4395 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
4397 else
4398 ereport(PANIC,
4400 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
4401 XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, r, sizeof(ControlFileData))));
4402 }
4404
4405 close(fd);
4406
4407 /*
4408 * Check for expected pg_control format version. If this is wrong, the
4409 * CRC check will likely fail because we'll be checking the wrong number
4410 * of bytes. Complaining about wrong version will probably be more
4411 * enlightening than complaining about wrong CRC.
4412 */
4413
4415 ereport(FATAL,
4416 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4417 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4418 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x),"
4419 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d (0x%08x).",
4422 errhint("This could be a problem of mismatched byte ordering. It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4423
4425 ereport(FATAL,
4426 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4427 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4428 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d,"
4429 " but the server was compiled with PG_CONTROL_VERSION %d.",
4431 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4432
4433 /* Now check the CRC. */
4437 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
4438 FIN_CRC32C(crc);
4439
4440 if (!EQ_CRC32C(crc, ControlFile->crc))
4441 ereport(FATAL,
4442 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4443 errmsg("incorrect checksum in control file")));
4444
4445 /*
4446 * Do compatibility checking immediately. If the database isn't
4447 * compatible with the backend executable, we want to abort before we can
4448 * possibly do any damage.
4449 */
4451 ereport(FATAL,
4452 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4453 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4454 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4455 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4456 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4457 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", ControlFile->catalog_version_no,
4458 "CATALOG_VERSION_NO", CATALOG_VERSION_NO),
4459 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4460 if (ControlFile->maxAlign != MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF)
4461 ereport(FATAL,
4462 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4463 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4464 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4465 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4466 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4467 "MAXALIGN", ControlFile->maxAlign,
4468 "MAXALIGN", MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF),
4469 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4471 ereport(FATAL,
4472 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4473 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4474 errdetail("The database cluster appears to use a different floating-point number format than the server executable."),
4475 errhint("It looks like you need to initdb.")));
4476 if (ControlFile->blcksz != BLCKSZ)
4477 ereport(FATAL,
4478 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4479 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4480 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4481 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4482 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4483 "BLCKSZ", ControlFile->blcksz,
4484 "BLCKSZ", BLCKSZ),
4485 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4486 if (ControlFile->relseg_size != RELSEG_SIZE)
4487 ereport(FATAL,
4488 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4489 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4490 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4491 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4492 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4493 "RELSEG_SIZE", ControlFile->relseg_size,
4494 "RELSEG_SIZE", RELSEG_SIZE),
4495 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4497 ereport(FATAL,
4498 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4499 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4500 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4501 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4502 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4503 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", ControlFile->slru_pages_per_segment,
4504 "SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT", SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT),
4505 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4506 if (ControlFile->xlog_blcksz != XLOG_BLCKSZ)
4507 ereport(FATAL,
4508 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4509 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4510 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4511 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4512 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4513 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", ControlFile->xlog_blcksz,
4514 "XLOG_BLCKSZ", XLOG_BLCKSZ),
4515 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4517 ereport(FATAL,
4518 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4519 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4520 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4521 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4522 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4523 "NAMEDATALEN", ControlFile->nameDataLen,
4524 "NAMEDATALEN", NAMEDATALEN),
4525 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4527 ereport(FATAL,
4528 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4529 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4530 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4531 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4532 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4533 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", ControlFile->indexMaxKeys,
4534 "INDEX_MAX_KEYS", INDEX_MAX_KEYS),
4535 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4537 ereport(FATAL,
4538 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4539 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4540 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4541 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4542 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4543 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", ControlFile->toast_max_chunk_size,
4544 "TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE", (int) TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE),
4545 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4547 ereport(FATAL,
4548 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
4549 errmsg("database files are incompatible with server"),
4550 /* translator: %s is a variable name and %d is its value */
4551 errdetail("The database cluster was initialized with %s %d,"
4552 " but the server was compiled with %s %d.",
4553 "LOBLKSIZE", ControlFile->loblksize,
4554 "LOBLKSIZE", (int) LOBLKSIZE),
4555 errhint("It looks like you need to recompile or initdb.")));
4556
4557 Assert(ControlFile->float8ByVal); /* vestigial, not worth an error msg */
4558
4560
4562 ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
4563 errmsg_plural("invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d byte)",
4564 "invalid WAL segment size in control file (%d bytes)",
4567 errdetail("The WAL segment size must be a power of two between 1 MB and 1 GB.")));
4568
4569 snprintf(wal_segsz_str, sizeof(wal_segsz_str), "%d", wal_segment_size);
4570 SetConfigOption("wal_segment_size", wal_segsz_str, PGC_INTERNAL,
4572
4573 /* check and update variables dependent on wal_segment_size */
4575 ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
4576 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4577 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4578 "min_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4579
4581 ereport(ERROR, (errcode(ERRCODE_INVALID_PARAMETER_VALUE),
4582 /* translator: both %s are GUC names */
4583 errmsg("\"%s\" must be at least twice \"%s\"",
4584 "max_wal_size", "wal_segment_size")));
4585
4587 (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ * UsableBytesInPage) -
4589
4591
4592 /* Make the initdb settings visible as GUC variables, too */
4593 SetConfigOption("data_checksums", DataChecksumsEnabled() ? "yes" : "no",
4595}
#define PG_BINARY
Definition: c.h:1271
#define CATALOG_VERSION_NO
Definition: catversion.h:60
int errmsg_plural(const char *fmt_singular, const char *fmt_plural, unsigned long n,...)
Definition: elog.c:1193
int BasicOpenFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition: fd.c:1086
void SetConfigOption(const char *name, const char *value, GucContext context, GucSource source)
Definition: guc.c:4196
@ PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT
Definition: guc.h:114
@ PGC_INTERNAL
Definition: guc.h:73
#define TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE
Definition: heaptoast.h:84
#define read(a, b, c)
Definition: win32.h:13
#define LOBLKSIZE
Definition: large_object.h:70
#define INDEX_MAX_KEYS
#define NAMEDATALEN
#define SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT
#define FLOATFORMAT_VALUE
Definition: pg_control.h:201
#define PG_CONTROL_VERSION
Definition: pg_control.h:25
#define EQ_CRC32C(c1, c2)
Definition: pg_crc32c.h:42
uint32 pg_control_version
Definition: pg_control.h:125
uint32 xlog_seg_size
Definition: pg_control.h:213
uint32 nameDataLen
Definition: pg_control.h:215
uint32 slru_pages_per_segment
Definition: pg_control.h:210
uint32 indexMaxKeys
Definition: pg_control.h:216
uint32 relseg_size
Definition: pg_control.h:208
uint32 catalog_version_no
Definition: pg_control.h:126
double floatFormat
Definition: pg_control.h:200
uint32 xlog_blcksz
Definition: pg_control.h:212
uint32 loblksize
Definition: pg_control.h:219
pg_crc32c crc
Definition: pg_control.h:240
uint32 toast_max_chunk_size
Definition: pg_control.h:218
#define UsableBytesInPage
Definition: xlog.c:598
bool DataChecksumsEnabled(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4631
static int UsableBytesInSegment
Definition: xlog.c:607
int min_wal_size_mb
Definition: xlog.c:117
#define XLOG_CONTROL_FILE

References Assert(), BasicOpenFile(), ControlFileData::blcksz, CalculateCheckpointSegments(), CATALOG_VERSION_NO, ControlFileData::catalog_version_no, close, COMP_CRC32C, ControlFile, ConvertToXSegs, ControlFileData::crc, crc, DataChecksumsEnabled(), EQ_CRC32C, ereport, errcode(), ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED, errcode_for_file_access(), errdetail(), errhint(), errmsg(), errmsg_plural(), ERROR, FATAL, fd(), FIN_CRC32C, ControlFileData::float8ByVal, ControlFileData::floatFormat, FLOATFORMAT_VALUE, INDEX_MAX_KEYS, ControlFileData::indexMaxKeys, INIT_CRC32C, IsValidWalSegSize, ControlFileData::loblksize, LOBLKSIZE, max_wal_size_mb, ControlFileData::maxAlign, min_wal_size_mb, ControlFileData::nameDataLen, NAMEDATALEN, PANIC, PG_BINARY, PG_CONTROL_VERSION, ControlFileData::pg_control_version, PGC_INTERNAL, PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT, pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), read, ControlFileData::relseg_size, SetConfigOption(), SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, ControlFileData::slru_pages_per_segment, SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT, snprintf, TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE, ControlFileData::toast_max_chunk_size, UsableBytesInPage, UsableBytesInSegment, wal_segment_size, ControlFileData::xlog_blcksz, XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, and ControlFileData::xlog_seg_size.

Referenced by BootStrapXLOG(), and LocalProcessControlFile().

◆ RecoveryInProgress()

bool RecoveryInProgress ( void  )

Definition at line 6404 of file xlog.c.

6405{
6406 /*
6407 * We check shared state each time only until we leave recovery mode. We
6408 * can't re-enter recovery, so there's no need to keep checking after the
6409 * shared variable has once been seen false.
6410 */
6412 return false;
6413 else
6414 {
6415 /*
6416 * use volatile pointer to make sure we make a fresh read of the
6417 * shared variable.
6418 */
6419 volatile XLogCtlData *xlogctl = XLogCtl;
6420
6422
6423 /*
6424 * Note: We don't need a memory barrier when we're still in recovery.
6425 * We might exit recovery immediately after return, so the caller
6426 * can't rely on 'true' meaning that we're still in recovery anyway.
6427 */
6428
6430 }
6431}
static bool LocalRecoveryInProgress
Definition: xlog.c:226

References LocalRecoveryInProgress, RECOVERY_STATE_DONE, XLogCtlData::SharedRecoveryState, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by amcheck_index_mainfork_expected(), attribute_statistics_update(), BackgroundWriterMain(), BeginReportingGUCOptions(), brin_desummarize_range(), brin_summarize_range(), CanInvalidateIdleSlot(), check_transaction_isolation(), check_transaction_read_only(), CheckArchiveTimeout(), CheckLogicalDecodingRequirements(), CheckpointerMain(), ComputeXidHorizons(), CreateCheckPoint(), CreateDecodingContext(), CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(), CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(), CreateRestartPoint(), do_pg_backup_start(), do_pg_backup_stop(), error_commit_ts_disabled(), ExecCheckpoint(), get_relation_info(), GetCurrentLSN(), GetLatestLSN(), GetNewMultiXactId(), GetNewObjectId(), GetNewTransactionId(), GetOldestActiveTransactionId(), GetOldestSafeDecodingTransactionId(), GetRunningTransactionData(), GetSerializableTransactionSnapshot(), GetSerializableTransactionSnapshotInt(), GetSnapshotData(), GetStrictOldestNonRemovableTransactionId(), gin_clean_pending_list(), GlobalVisHorizonKindForRel(), heap_force_common(), heap_page_prune_opt(), IdentifySystem(), InitTempTableNamespace(), InitWalSender(), IsCheckpointOnSchedule(), LockAcquireExtended(), logical_read_xlog_page(), MaintainLatestCompletedXid(), MarkBufferDirtyHint(), perform_base_backup(), pg_clear_attribute_stats(), pg_create_restore_point(), pg_current_wal_flush_lsn(), pg_current_wal_insert_lsn(), pg_current_wal_lsn(), pg_get_sequence_data(), pg_get_wal_replay_pause_state(), pg_is_in_recovery(), pg_is_wal_replay_paused(), pg_log_standby_snapshot(), pg_logical_slot_get_changes_guts(), pg_promote(), pg_replication_slot_advance(), pg_sequence_last_value(), pg_switch_wal(), pg_sync_replication_slots(), pg_wal_replay_pause(), pg_wal_replay_resume(), pg_walfile_name(), pg_walfile_name_offset(), pgstat_report_replslotsync(), PhysicalWakeupLogicalWalSnd(), PrepareRedoAdd(), PrepareRedoRemoveFull(), PreventCommandDuringRecovery(), ProcessStandbyPSRequestMessage(), ProcSleep(), read_local_xlog_page_guts(), ReadReplicationSlot(), recovery_create_dbdir(), relation_statistics_update(), ReplicationSlotAlter(), ReplicationSlotCreate(), ReplicationSlotDrop(), ReplicationSlotReserveWal(), replorigin_check_prerequisites(), ReportChangedGUCOptions(), sendDir(), SerialSetActiveSerXmin(), show_in_hot_standby(), ShutdownXLOG(), SnapBuildWaitSnapshot(), StandbySlotsHaveCaughtup(), StartLogicalReplication(), StartReplication(), StartTransaction(), TransactionIdIsInProgress(), TruncateMultiXact(), UpdateFullPageWrites(), verify_heapam(), WaitForLSN(), WALReadFromBuffers(), WalReceiverMain(), WalSndWaitForWal(), xlog_decode(), XLogBackgroundFlush(), XLogFlush(), XLogInsertAllowed(), and XLogSendPhysical().

◆ RecoveryRestartPoint()

static void RecoveryRestartPoint ( const CheckPoint checkPoint,
XLogReaderState record 
)
static

Definition at line 7617 of file xlog.c.

7618{
7619 /*
7620 * Also refrain from creating a restartpoint if we have seen any
7621 * references to non-existent pages. Restarting recovery from the
7622 * restartpoint would not see the references, so we would lose the
7623 * cross-check that the pages belonged to a relation that was dropped
7624 * later.
7625 */
7627 {
7628 elog(DEBUG2,
7629 "could not record restart point at %X/%08X because there are unresolved references to invalid pages",
7630 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(checkPoint->redo));
7631 return;
7632 }
7633
7634 /*
7635 * Copy the checkpoint record to shared memory, so that checkpointer can
7636 * work out the next time it wants to perform a restartpoint.
7637 */
7641 XLogCtl->lastCheckPoint = *checkPoint;
7643}
XLogRecPtr EndRecPtr
Definition: xlogreader.h:206
XLogRecPtr ReadRecPtr
Definition: xlogreader.h:205
bool XLogHaveInvalidPages(void)
Definition: xlogutils.c:224

References DEBUG2, elog, XLogReaderState::EndRecPtr, XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::lastCheckPoint, XLogCtlData::lastCheckPointEndPtr, XLogCtlData::lastCheckPointRecPtr, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, XLogReaderState::ReadRecPtr, CheckPoint::redo, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, XLogCtl, and XLogHaveInvalidPages().

Referenced by xlog_redo().

◆ register_persistent_abort_backup_handler()

void register_persistent_abort_backup_handler ( void  )

Definition at line 9483 of file xlog.c.

9484{
9485 static bool already_done = false;
9486
9487 if (already_done)
9488 return;
9490 already_done = true;
9491}
void before_shmem_exit(pg_on_exit_callback function, Datum arg)
Definition: ipc.c:337

References before_shmem_exit(), BoolGetDatum(), and do_pg_abort_backup().

Referenced by pg_backup_start().

◆ RemoveNonParentXlogFiles()

void RemoveNonParentXlogFiles ( XLogRecPtr  switchpoint,
TimeLineID  newTLI 
)

Definition at line 3961 of file xlog.c.

3962{
3963 DIR *xldir;
3964 struct dirent *xlde;
3965 char switchseg[MAXFNAMELEN];
3966 XLogSegNo endLogSegNo;
3967 XLogSegNo switchLogSegNo;
3968 XLogSegNo recycleSegNo;
3969
3970 /*
3971 * Initialize info about where to begin the work. This will recycle,
3972 * somewhat arbitrarily, 10 future segments.
3973 */
3974 XLByteToPrevSeg(switchpoint, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
3975 XLByteToSeg(switchpoint, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
3976 recycleSegNo = endLogSegNo + 10;
3977
3978 /*
3979 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept.
3980 */
3981 XLogFileName(switchseg, newTLI, switchLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
3982
3983 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments newer than log file %s",
3984 switchseg);
3985
3986 xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
3987
3988 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3989 {
3990 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
3991 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3992 continue;
3993
3994 /*
3995 * Remove files that are on a timeline older than the new one we're
3996 * switching to, but with a segment number >= the first segment on the
3997 * new timeline.
3998 */
3999 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, switchseg, 8) < 0 &&
4000 strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, switchseg + 8) > 0)
4001 {
4002 /*
4003 * If the file has already been marked as .ready, however, don't
4004 * remove it yet. It should be OK to remove it - files that are
4005 * not part of our timeline history are not required for recovery
4006 * - but seems safer to let them be archived and removed later.
4007 */
4008 if (!XLogArchiveIsReady(xlde->d_name))
4009 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endLogSegNo, newTLI);
4010 }
4011 }
4012
4013 FreeDir(xldir);
4014}
static void RemoveXlogFile(const struct dirent *segment_de, XLogSegNo recycleSegNo, XLogSegNo *endlogSegNo, TimeLineID insertTLI)
Definition: xlog.c:4030
static bool IsXLogFileName(const char *fname)
bool XLogArchiveIsReady(const char *xlog)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:694

References AllocateDir(), dirent::d_name, DEBUG2, elog, FreeDir(), IsXLogFileName(), MAXFNAMELEN, ReadDir(), RemoveXlogFile(), wal_segment_size, XLByteToPrevSeg, XLByteToSeg, XLogArchiveIsReady(), XLOGDIR, and XLogFileName().

Referenced by ApplyWalRecord(), and CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery().

◆ RemoveOldXlogFiles()

static void RemoveOldXlogFiles ( XLogSegNo  segno,
XLogRecPtr  lastredoptr,
XLogRecPtr  endptr,
TimeLineID  insertTLI 
)
static

Definition at line 3886 of file xlog.c.

3888{
3889 DIR *xldir;
3890 struct dirent *xlde;
3891 char lastoff[MAXFNAMELEN];
3892 XLogSegNo endlogSegNo;
3893 XLogSegNo recycleSegNo;
3894
3895 /* Initialize info about where to try to recycle to */
3896 XLByteToSeg(endptr, endlogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
3897 recycleSegNo = XLOGfileslop(lastredoptr);
3898
3899 /*
3900 * Construct a filename of the last segment to be kept. The timeline ID
3901 * doesn't matter, we ignore that in the comparison. (During recovery,
3902 * InsertTimeLineID isn't set, so we can't use that.)
3903 */
3904 XLogFileName(lastoff, 0, segno, wal_segment_size);
3905
3906 elog(DEBUG2, "attempting to remove WAL segments older than log file %s",
3907 lastoff);
3908
3909 xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
3910
3911 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3912 {
3913 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments */
3914 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name) &&
3916 continue;
3917
3918 /*
3919 * We ignore the timeline part of the XLOG segment identifiers in
3920 * deciding whether a segment is still needed. This ensures that we
3921 * won't prematurely remove a segment from a parent timeline. We could
3922 * probably be a little more proactive about removing segments of
3923 * non-parent timelines, but that would be a whole lot more
3924 * complicated.
3925 *
3926 * We use the alphanumeric sorting property of the filenames to decide
3927 * which ones are earlier than the lastoff segment.
3928 */
3929 if (strcmp(xlde->d_name + 8, lastoff + 8) <= 0)
3930 {
3931 if (XLogArchiveCheckDone(xlde->d_name))
3932 {
3933 /* Update the last removed location in shared memory first */
3935
3936 RemoveXlogFile(xlde, recycleSegNo, &endlogSegNo, insertTLI);
3937 }
3938 }
3939 }
3940
3941 FreeDir(xldir);
3942}
static XLogSegNo XLOGfileslop(XLogRecPtr lastredoptr)
Definition: xlog.c:2233
static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr(char *filename)
Definition: xlog.c:3833
static bool IsPartialXLogFileName(const char *fname)

References AllocateDir(), dirent::d_name, DEBUG2, elog, FreeDir(), IsPartialXLogFileName(), IsXLogFileName(), MAXFNAMELEN, ReadDir(), RemoveXlogFile(), UpdateLastRemovedPtr(), wal_segment_size, XLByteToSeg, XLogArchiveCheckDone(), XLOGDIR, XLogFileName(), and XLOGfileslop().

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), and CreateRestartPoint().

◆ RemoveTempXlogFiles()

static void RemoveTempXlogFiles ( void  )
static

Definition at line 3853 of file xlog.c.

3854{
3855 DIR *xldir;
3856 struct dirent *xlde;
3857
3858 elog(DEBUG2, "removing all temporary WAL segments");
3859
3860 xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
3861 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3862 {
3863 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3864
3865 if (strncmp(xlde->d_name, "xlogtemp.", 9) != 0)
3866 continue;
3867
3868 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", xlde->d_name);
3869 unlink(path);
3870 elog(DEBUG2, "removed temporary WAL segment \"%s\"", path);
3871 }
3872 FreeDir(xldir);
3873}

References AllocateDir(), dirent::d_name, DEBUG2, elog, FreeDir(), MAXPGPATH, ReadDir(), snprintf, and XLOGDIR.

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ RemoveXlogFile()

static void RemoveXlogFile ( const struct dirent segment_de,
XLogSegNo  recycleSegNo,
XLogSegNo endlogSegNo,
TimeLineID  insertTLI 
)
static

Definition at line 4030 of file xlog.c.

4033{
4034 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4035#ifdef WIN32
4036 char newpath[MAXPGPATH];
4037#endif
4038 const char *segname = segment_de->d_name;
4039
4040 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/%s", segname);
4041
4042 /*
4043 * Before deleting the file, see if it can be recycled as a future log
4044 * segment. Only recycle normal files, because we don't want to recycle
4045 * symbolic links pointing to a separate archive directory.
4046 */
4047 if (wal_recycle &&
4048 *endlogSegNo <= recycleSegNo &&
4049 XLogCtl->InstallXLogFileSegmentActive && /* callee rechecks this */
4050 get_dirent_type(path, segment_de, false, DEBUG2) == PGFILETYPE_REG &&
4051 InstallXLogFileSegment(endlogSegNo, path,
4052 true, recycleSegNo, insertTLI))
4053 {
4055 (errmsg_internal("recycled write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4056 segname)));
4058 /* Needn't recheck that slot on future iterations */
4059 (*endlogSegNo)++;
4060 }
4061 else
4062 {
4063 /* No need for any more future segments, or recycling failed ... */
4064 int rc;
4065
4067 (errmsg_internal("removing write-ahead log file \"%s\"",
4068 segname)));
4069
4070#ifdef WIN32
4071
4072 /*
4073 * On Windows, if another process (e.g another backend) holds the file
4074 * open in FILE_SHARE_DELETE mode, unlink will succeed, but the file
4075 * will still show up in directory listing until the last handle is
4076 * closed. To avoid confusing the lingering deleted file for a live
4077 * WAL file that needs to be archived, rename it before deleting it.
4078 *
4079 * If another process holds the file open without FILE_SHARE_DELETE
4080 * flag, rename will fail. We'll try again at the next checkpoint.
4081 */
4082 snprintf(newpath, MAXPGPATH, "%s.deleted", path);
4083 if (rename(path, newpath) != 0)
4084 {
4085 ereport(LOG,
4087 errmsg("could not rename file \"%s\": %m",
4088 path)));
4089 return;
4090 }
4091 rc = durable_unlink(newpath, LOG);
4092#else
4093 rc = durable_unlink(path, LOG);
4094#endif
4095 if (rc != 0)
4096 {
4097 /* Message already logged by durable_unlink() */
4098 return;
4099 }
4101 }
4102
4103 XLogArchiveCleanup(segname);
4104}
@ PGFILETYPE_REG
Definition: file_utils.h:22
static bool InstallXLogFileSegment(XLogSegNo *segno, char *tmppath, bool find_free, XLogSegNo max_segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition: xlog.c:3584
bool wal_recycle
Definition: xlog.c:130

References CheckpointStats, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_recycled, CheckpointStatsData::ckpt_segs_removed, dirent::d_name, DEBUG2, durable_unlink(), ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), errmsg_internal(), get_dirent_type(), InstallXLogFileSegment(), XLogCtlData::InstallXLogFileSegmentActive, LOG, MAXPGPATH, PGFILETYPE_REG, snprintf, wal_recycle, XLogArchiveCleanup(), XLogCtl, and XLOGDIR.

Referenced by RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(), and RemoveOldXlogFiles().

◆ RequestXLogSwitch()

XLogRecPtr RequestXLogSwitch ( bool  mark_unimportant)

Definition at line 8128 of file xlog.c.

8129{
8130 XLogRecPtr RecPtr;
8131
8132 /* XLOG SWITCH has no data */
8134
8135 if (mark_unimportant)
8137 RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_SWITCH);
8138
8139 return RecPtr;
8140}
#define XLOG_SWITCH
Definition: pg_control.h:72
#define XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT
Definition: xlog.h:155
void XLogSetRecordFlags(uint8 flags)
Definition: xloginsert.c:460

References XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT, XLOG_SWITCH, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogInsert(), and XLogSetRecordFlags().

Referenced by CheckArchiveTimeout(), do_pg_backup_start(), do_pg_backup_stop(), pg_switch_wal(), and ShutdownXLOG().

◆ ReserveXLogInsertLocation()

static pg_attribute_always_inline void ReserveXLogInsertLocation ( int  size,
XLogRecPtr StartPos,
XLogRecPtr EndPos,
XLogRecPtr PrevPtr 
)
static

Definition at line 1114 of file xlog.c.

1116{
1118 uint64 startbytepos;
1119 uint64 endbytepos;
1120 uint64 prevbytepos;
1121
1122 size = MAXALIGN(size);
1123
1124 /* All (non xlog-switch) records should contain data. */
1125 Assert(size > SizeOfXLogRecord);
1126
1127 /*
1128 * The duration the spinlock needs to be held is minimized by minimizing
1129 * the calculations that have to be done while holding the lock. The
1130 * current tip of reserved WAL is kept in CurrBytePos, as a byte position
1131 * that only counts "usable" bytes in WAL, that is, it excludes all WAL
1132 * page headers. The mapping between "usable" byte positions and physical
1133 * positions (XLogRecPtrs) can be done outside the locked region, and
1134 * because the usable byte position doesn't include any headers, reserving
1135 * X bytes from WAL is almost as simple as "CurrBytePos += X".
1136 */
1137 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1138
1139 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1140 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1141 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1142 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1143 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1144
1145 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1146
1147 *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
1148 *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
1149 *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
1150
1151 /*
1152 * Check that the conversions between "usable byte positions" and
1153 * XLogRecPtrs work consistently in both directions.
1154 */
1155 Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
1156 Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
1157 Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
1158}
#define MAXALIGN(LEN)
Definition: c.h:824
static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(uint64 bytepos)
Definition: xlog.c:1904
static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos(XLogRecPtr ptr)
Definition: xlog.c:1947

References Assert(), XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), MAXALIGN, SizeOfXLogRecord, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(), XLogBytePosToRecPtr(), XLogCtl, and XLogRecPtrToBytePos().

Referenced by XLogInsertRecord().

◆ ReserveXLogSwitch()

static bool ReserveXLogSwitch ( XLogRecPtr StartPos,
XLogRecPtr EndPos,
XLogRecPtr PrevPtr 
)
static

Definition at line 1170 of file xlog.c.

1171{
1173 uint64 startbytepos;
1174 uint64 endbytepos;
1175 uint64 prevbytepos;
1177 XLogRecPtr ptr;
1178 uint32 segleft;
1179
1180 /*
1181 * These calculations are a bit heavy-weight to be done while holding a
1182 * spinlock, but since we're holding all the WAL insertion locks, there
1183 * are no other inserters competing for it. GetXLogInsertRecPtr() does
1184 * compete for it, but that's not called very frequently.
1185 */
1186 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1187
1188 startbytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1189
1190 ptr = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(startbytepos);
1191 if (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size) == 0)
1192 {
1193 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1194 *EndPos = *StartPos = ptr;
1195 return false;
1196 }
1197
1198 endbytepos = startbytepos + size;
1199 prevbytepos = Insert->PrevBytePos;
1200
1201 *StartPos = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(startbytepos);
1202 *EndPos = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(endbytepos);
1203
1205 if (segleft != wal_segment_size)
1206 {
1207 /* consume the rest of the segment */
1208 *EndPos += segleft;
1209 endbytepos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos);
1210 }
1211 Insert->CurrBytePos = endbytepos;
1212 Insert->PrevBytePos = startbytepos;
1213
1214 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1215
1216 *PrevPtr = XLogBytePosToRecPtr(prevbytepos);
1217
1219 Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*EndPos) == endbytepos);
1220 Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*StartPos) == startbytepos);
1221 Assert(XLogRecPtrToBytePos(*PrevPtr) == prevbytepos);
1222
1223 return true;
1224}

References Assert(), XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), MAXALIGN, SizeOfXLogRecord, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, wal_segment_size, XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(), XLogBytePosToRecPtr(), XLogCtl, XLogRecPtrToBytePos(), and XLogSegmentOffset.

Referenced by XLogInsertRecord().

◆ ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive()

void ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive ( void  )

Definition at line 9554 of file xlog.c.

9555{
9556 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
9558 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
9559}

References XLogCtlData::InstallXLogFileSegmentActive, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), and XLogCtl.

Referenced by WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable(), and XLogShutdownWalRcv().

◆ SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive()

void SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive ( void  )

Definition at line 9545 of file xlog.c.

9546{
9547 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
9549 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
9550}

References XLogCtlData::InstallXLogFileSegmentActive, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), and XLogCtl.

Referenced by BootStrapXLOG(), StartupXLOG(), and WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable().

◆ SetWalWriterSleeping()

void SetWalWriterSleeping ( bool  sleeping)

Definition at line 9577 of file xlog.c.

9578{
9580 XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = sleeping;
9582}
bool WalWriterSleeping
Definition: xlog.c:534

References XLogCtlData::info_lck, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, XLogCtlData::WalWriterSleeping, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by WalWriterMain().

◆ show_archive_command()

const char * show_archive_command ( void  )

Definition at line 4868 of file xlog.c.

4869{
4870 if (XLogArchivingActive())
4871 return XLogArchiveCommand;
4872 else
4873 return "(disabled)";
4874}
char * XLogArchiveCommand
Definition: xlog.c:122

References XLogArchiveCommand, and XLogArchivingActive.

◆ show_in_hot_standby()

const char * show_in_hot_standby ( void  )

Definition at line 4880 of file xlog.c.

4881{
4882 /*
4883 * We display the actual state based on shared memory, so that this GUC
4884 * reports up-to-date state if examined intra-query. The underlying
4885 * variable (in_hot_standby_guc) changes only when we transmit a new value
4886 * to the client.
4887 */
4888 return RecoveryInProgress() ? "on" : "off";
4889}

References RecoveryInProgress().

◆ ShutdownXLOG()

void ShutdownXLOG ( int  code,
Datum  arg 
)

Definition at line 6672 of file xlog.c.

6673{
6674 /*
6675 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
6676 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
6677 */
6679 Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
6682
6683 /* Don't be chatty in standalone mode */
6685 (errmsg("shutting down")));
6686
6687 /*
6688 * Signal walsenders to move to stopping state.
6689 */
6691
6692 /*
6693 * Wait for WAL senders to be in stopping state. This prevents commands
6694 * from writing new WAL.
6695 */
6697
6698 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6700 else
6701 {
6702 /*
6703 * If archiving is enabled, rotate the last XLOG file so that all the
6704 * remaining records are archived (postmaster wakes up the archiver
6705 * process one more time at the end of shutdown). The checkpoint
6706 * record will go to the next XLOG file and won't be archived (yet).
6707 */
6708 if (XLogArchivingActive())
6709 RequestXLogSwitch(false);
6710
6712 }
6713}
bool IsPostmasterEnvironment
Definition: globals.c:119
ResourceOwner CurrentResourceOwner
Definition: resowner.c:173
ResourceOwner AuxProcessResourceOwner
Definition: resowner.c:176
void WalSndInitStopping(void)
Definition: walsender.c:3872
void WalSndWaitStopping(void)
Definition: walsender.c:3898
bool CreateRestartPoint(int flags)
Definition: xlog.c:7657
bool CreateCheckPoint(int flags)
Definition: xlog.c:6959

References Assert(), AuxProcessResourceOwner, CHECKPOINT_FAST, CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN, CreateCheckPoint(), CreateRestartPoint(), CurrentResourceOwner, ereport, errmsg(), IsPostmasterEnvironment, LOG, NOTICE, RecoveryInProgress(), RequestXLogSwitch(), WalSndInitStopping(), WalSndWaitStopping(), and XLogArchivingActive.

Referenced by CheckpointerMain(), and InitPostgres().

◆ StartupXLOG()

void StartupXLOG ( void  )

Definition at line 5481 of file xlog.c.

5482{
5484 CheckPoint checkPoint;
5485 bool wasShutdown;
5486 bool didCrash;
5487 bool haveTblspcMap;
5488 bool haveBackupLabel;
5489 XLogRecPtr EndOfLog;
5490 TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI;
5491 TimeLineID newTLI;
5492 bool performedWalRecovery;
5493 EndOfWalRecoveryInfo *endOfRecoveryInfo;
5496 TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
5497 bool promoted = false;
5498 char timebuf[128];
5499
5500 /*
5501 * We should have an aux process resource owner to use, and we should not
5502 * be in a transaction that's installed some other resowner.
5503 */
5505 Assert(CurrentResourceOwner == NULL ||
5508
5509 /*
5510 * Check that contents look valid.
5511 */
5513 ereport(FATAL,
5515 errmsg("control file contains invalid checkpoint location")));
5516
5517 switch (ControlFile->state)
5518 {
5519 case DB_SHUTDOWNED:
5520
5521 /*
5522 * This is the expected case, so don't be chatty in standalone
5523 * mode
5524 */
5526 (errmsg("database system was shut down at %s",
5528 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5529 break;
5530
5532 ereport(LOG,
5533 (errmsg("database system was shut down in recovery at %s",
5535 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5536 break;
5537
5538 case DB_SHUTDOWNING:
5539 ereport(LOG,
5540 (errmsg("database system shutdown was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5542 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5543 break;
5544
5546 ereport(LOG,
5547 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at %s",
5549 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5550 errhint("This probably means that some data is corrupted and"
5551 " you will have to use the last backup for recovery.")));
5552 break;
5553
5555 ereport(LOG,
5556 (errmsg("database system was interrupted while in recovery at log time %s",
5558 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf))),
5559 errhint("If this has occurred more than once some data might be corrupted"
5560 " and you might need to choose an earlier recovery target.")));
5561 break;
5562
5563 case DB_IN_PRODUCTION:
5564 ereport(LOG,
5565 (errmsg("database system was interrupted; last known up at %s",
5567 timebuf, sizeof(timebuf)))));
5568 break;
5569
5570 default:
5571 ereport(FATAL,
5573 errmsg("control file contains invalid database cluster state")));
5574 }
5575
5576 /* This is just to allow attaching to startup process with a debugger */
5577#ifdef XLOG_REPLAY_DELAY
5579 pg_usleep(60000000L);
5580#endif
5581
5582 /*
5583 * Verify that pg_wal, pg_wal/archive_status, and pg_wal/summaries exist.
5584 * In cases where someone has performed a copy for PITR, these directories
5585 * may have been excluded and need to be re-created.
5586 */
5588
5589 /* Set up timeout handler needed to report startup progress. */
5593
5594 /*----------
5595 * If we previously crashed, perform a couple of actions:
5596 *
5597 * - The pg_wal directory may still include some temporary WAL segments
5598 * used when creating a new segment, so perform some clean up to not
5599 * bloat this path. This is done first as there is no point to sync
5600 * this temporary data.
5601 *
5602 * - There might be data which we had written, intending to fsync it, but
5603 * which we had not actually fsync'd yet. Therefore, a power failure in
5604 * the near future might cause earlier unflushed writes to be lost, even
5605 * though more recent data written to disk from here on would be
5606 * persisted. To avoid that, fsync the entire data directory.
5607 */
5610 {
5613 didCrash = true;
5614 }
5615 else
5616 didCrash = false;
5617
5618 /*
5619 * Prepare for WAL recovery if needed.
5620 *
5621 * InitWalRecovery analyzes the control file and the backup label file, if
5622 * any. It updates the in-memory ControlFile buffer according to the
5623 * starting checkpoint, and sets InRecovery and ArchiveRecoveryRequested.
5624 * It also applies the tablespace map file, if any.
5625 */
5626 InitWalRecovery(ControlFile, &wasShutdown,
5627 &haveBackupLabel, &haveTblspcMap);
5628 checkPoint = ControlFile->checkPointCopy;
5629
5630 /* initialize shared memory variables from the checkpoint record */
5631 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
5632 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
5634 MultiXactSetNextMXact(checkPoint.nextMulti, checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
5635 AdvanceOldestClogXid(checkPoint.oldestXid);
5636 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
5637 SetMultiXactIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestMulti, checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
5639 checkPoint.newestCommitTsXid);
5640
5641 /*
5642 * Clear out any old relcache cache files. This is *necessary* if we do
5643 * any WAL replay, since that would probably result in the cache files
5644 * being out of sync with database reality. In theory we could leave them
5645 * in place if the database had been cleanly shut down, but it seems
5646 * safest to just remove them always and let them be rebuilt during the
5647 * first backend startup. These files needs to be removed from all
5648 * directories including pg_tblspc, however the symlinks are created only
5649 * after reading tablespace_map file in case of archive recovery from
5650 * backup, so needs to clear old relcache files here after creating
5651 * symlinks.
5652 */
5654
5655 /*
5656 * Initialize replication slots, before there's a chance to remove
5657 * required resources.
5658 */
5660
5661 /*
5662 * Startup logical state, needs to be setup now so we have proper data
5663 * during crash recovery.
5664 */
5666
5667 /*
5668 * Startup CLOG. This must be done after TransamVariables->nextXid has
5669 * been initialized and before we accept connections or begin WAL replay.
5670 */
5671 StartupCLOG();
5672
5673 /*
5674 * Startup MultiXact. We need to do this early to be able to replay
5675 * truncations.
5676 */
5678
5679 /*
5680 * Ditto for commit timestamps. Activate the facility if the setting is
5681 * enabled in the control file, as there should be no tracking of commit
5682 * timestamps done when the setting was disabled. This facility can be
5683 * started or stopped when replaying a XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE record.
5684 */
5687
5688 /*
5689 * Recover knowledge about replay progress of known replication partners.
5690 */
5692
5693 /*
5694 * Initialize unlogged LSN. On a clean shutdown, it's restored from the
5695 * control file. On recovery, all unlogged relations are blown away, so
5696 * the unlogged LSN counter can be reset too.
5697 */
5701 else
5704
5705 /*
5706 * Copy any missing timeline history files between 'now' and the recovery
5707 * target timeline from archive to pg_wal. While we don't need those files
5708 * ourselves - the history file of the recovery target timeline covers all
5709 * the previous timelines in the history too - a cascading standby server
5710 * might be interested in them. Or, if you archive the WAL from this
5711 * server to a different archive than the primary, it'd be good for all
5712 * the history files to get archived there after failover, so that you can
5713 * use one of the old timelines as a PITR target. Timeline history files
5714 * are small, so it's better to copy them unnecessarily than not copy them
5715 * and regret later.
5716 */
5718
5719 /*
5720 * Before running in recovery, scan pg_twophase and fill in its status to
5721 * be able to work on entries generated by redo. Doing a scan before
5722 * taking any recovery action has the merit to discard any 2PC files that
5723 * are newer than the first record to replay, saving from any conflicts at
5724 * replay. This avoids as well any subsequent scans when doing recovery
5725 * of the on-disk two-phase data.
5726 */
5728
5729 /*
5730 * When starting with crash recovery, reset pgstat data - it might not be
5731 * valid. Otherwise restore pgstat data. It's safe to do this here,
5732 * because postmaster will not yet have started any other processes.
5733 *
5734 * NB: Restoring replication slot stats relies on slot state to have
5735 * already been restored from disk.
5736 *
5737 * TODO: With a bit of extra work we could just start with a pgstat file
5738 * associated with the checkpoint redo location we're starting from.
5739 */
5740 if (didCrash)
5742 else
5744
5746
5749
5750 /* REDO */
5751 if (InRecovery)
5752 {
5753 /* Initialize state for RecoveryInProgress() */
5757 else
5760
5761 /*
5762 * Update pg_control to show that we are recovering and to show the
5763 * selected checkpoint as the place we are starting from. We also mark
5764 * pg_control with any minimum recovery stop point obtained from a
5765 * backup history file.
5766 *
5767 * No need to hold ControlFileLock yet, we aren't up far enough.
5768 */
5770
5771 /*
5772 * If there was a backup label file, it's done its job and the info
5773 * has now been propagated into pg_control. We must get rid of the
5774 * label file so that if we crash during recovery, we'll pick up at
5775 * the latest recovery restartpoint instead of going all the way back
5776 * to the backup start point. It seems prudent though to just rename
5777 * the file out of the way rather than delete it completely.
5778 */
5779 if (haveBackupLabel)
5780 {
5781 unlink(BACKUP_LABEL_OLD);
5783 }
5784
5785 /*
5786 * If there was a tablespace_map file, it's done its job and the
5787 * symlinks have been created. We must get rid of the map file so
5788 * that if we crash during recovery, we don't create symlinks again.
5789 * It seems prudent though to just rename the file out of the way
5790 * rather than delete it completely.
5791 */
5792 if (haveTblspcMap)
5793 {
5794 unlink(TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD);
5796 }
5797
5798 /*
5799 * Initialize our local copy of minRecoveryPoint. When doing crash
5800 * recovery we want to replay up to the end of WAL. Particularly, in
5801 * the case of a promoted standby minRecoveryPoint value in the
5802 * control file is only updated after the first checkpoint. However,
5803 * if the instance crashes before the first post-recovery checkpoint
5804 * is completed then recovery will use a stale location causing the
5805 * startup process to think that there are still invalid page
5806 * references when checking for data consistency.
5807 */
5809 {
5812 }
5813 else
5814 {
5817 }
5818
5819 /* Check that the GUCs used to generate the WAL allow recovery */
5821
5822 /*
5823 * We're in recovery, so unlogged relations may be trashed and must be
5824 * reset. This should be done BEFORE allowing Hot Standby
5825 * connections, so that read-only backends don't try to read whatever
5826 * garbage is left over from before.
5827 */
5829
5830 /*
5831 * Likewise, delete any saved transaction snapshot files that got left
5832 * behind by crashed backends.
5833 */
5835
5836 /*
5837 * Initialize for Hot Standby, if enabled. We won't let backends in
5838 * yet, not until we've reached the min recovery point specified in
5839 * control file and we've established a recovery snapshot from a
5840 * running-xacts WAL record.
5841 */
5843 {
5844 TransactionId *xids;
5845 int nxids;
5846
5848 (errmsg_internal("initializing for hot standby")));
5849
5851
5852 if (wasShutdown)
5853 oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
5854 else
5855 oldestActiveXID = checkPoint.oldestActiveXid;
5856 Assert(TransactionIdIsValid(oldestActiveXID));
5857
5858 /* Tell procarray about the range of xids it has to deal with */
5860
5861 /*
5862 * Startup subtrans only. CLOG, MultiXact and commit timestamp
5863 * have already been started up and other SLRUs are not maintained
5864 * during recovery and need not be started yet.
5865 */
5866 StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
5867
5868 /*
5869 * If we're beginning at a shutdown checkpoint, we know that
5870 * nothing was running on the primary at this point. So fake-up an
5871 * empty running-xacts record and use that here and now. Recover
5872 * additional standby state for prepared transactions.
5873 */
5874 if (wasShutdown)
5875 {
5877 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
5878
5879 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
5881
5882 /*
5883 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a
5884 * shut down server, with only prepared transactions still
5885 * alive. We're never overflowed at this point because all
5886 * subxids are listed with their parent prepared transactions.
5887 */
5888 running.xcnt = nxids;
5889 running.subxcnt = 0;
5891 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5892 running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
5893 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
5894 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
5895 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
5896 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
5897 running.xids = xids;
5898
5900 }
5901 }
5902
5903 /*
5904 * We're all set for replaying the WAL now. Do it.
5905 */
5907 performedWalRecovery = true;
5908 }
5909 else
5910 performedWalRecovery = false;
5911
5912 /*
5913 * Finish WAL recovery.
5914 */
5915 endOfRecoveryInfo = FinishWalRecovery();
5916 EndOfLog = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLog;
5917 EndOfLogTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->endOfLogTLI;
5918 abortedRecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->abortedRecPtr;
5919 missingContrecPtr = endOfRecoveryInfo->missingContrecPtr;
5920
5921 /*
5922 * Reset ps status display, so as no information related to recovery shows
5923 * up.
5924 */
5925 set_ps_display("");
5926
5927 /*
5928 * When recovering from a backup (we are in recovery, and archive recovery
5929 * was requested), complain if we did not roll forward far enough to reach
5930 * the point where the database is consistent. For regular online
5931 * backup-from-primary, that means reaching the end-of-backup WAL record
5932 * (at which point we reset backupStartPoint to be Invalid), for
5933 * backup-from-replica (which can't inject records into the WAL stream),
5934 * that point is when we reach the minRecoveryPoint in pg_control (which
5935 * we purposefully copy last when backing up from a replica). For
5936 * pg_rewind (which creates a backup_label with a method of "pg_rewind")
5937 * or snapshot-style backups (which don't), backupEndRequired will be set
5938 * to false.
5939 *
5940 * Note: it is indeed okay to look at the local variable
5941 * LocalMinRecoveryPoint here, even though ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint
5942 * might be further ahead --- ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint cannot have
5943 * been advanced beyond the WAL we processed.
5944 */
5945 if (InRecovery &&
5946 (EndOfLog < LocalMinRecoveryPoint ||
5948 {
5949 /*
5950 * Ran off end of WAL before reaching end-of-backup WAL record, or
5951 * minRecoveryPoint. That's a bad sign, indicating that you tried to
5952 * recover from an online backup but never called pg_backup_stop(), or
5953 * you didn't archive all the WAL needed.
5954 */
5956 {
5958 ereport(FATAL,
5959 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
5960 errmsg("WAL ends before end of online backup"),
5961 errhint("All WAL generated while online backup was taken must be available at recovery.")));
5962 else
5963 ereport(FATAL,
5964 (errcode(ERRCODE_OBJECT_NOT_IN_PREREQUISITE_STATE),
5965 errmsg("WAL ends before consistent recovery point")));
5966 }
5967 }
5968
5969 /*
5970 * Reset unlogged relations to the contents of their INIT fork. This is
5971 * done AFTER recovery is complete so as to include any unlogged relations
5972 * created during recovery, but BEFORE recovery is marked as having
5973 * completed successfully. Otherwise we'd not retry if any of the post
5974 * end-of-recovery steps fail.
5975 */
5976 if (InRecovery)
5978
5979 /*
5980 * Pre-scan prepared transactions to find out the range of XIDs present.
5981 * This information is not quite needed yet, but it is positioned here so
5982 * as potential problems are detected before any on-disk change is done.
5983 */
5984 oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(NULL, NULL);
5985
5986 /*
5987 * Allow ordinary WAL segment creation before possibly switching to a new
5988 * timeline, which creates a new segment, and after the last ReadRecord().
5989 */
5991
5992 /*
5993 * Consider whether we need to assign a new timeline ID.
5994 *
5995 * If we did archive recovery, we always assign a new ID. This handles a
5996 * couple of issues. If we stopped short of the end of WAL during
5997 * recovery, then we are clearly generating a new timeline and must assign
5998 * it a unique new ID. Even if we ran to the end, modifying the current
5999 * last segment is problematic because it may result in trying to
6000 * overwrite an already-archived copy of that segment, and we encourage
6001 * DBAs to make their archive_commands reject that. We can dodge the
6002 * problem by making the new active segment have a new timeline ID.
6003 *
6004 * In a normal crash recovery, we can just extend the timeline we were in.
6005 */
6006 newTLI = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
6008 {
6010 ereport(LOG,
6011 (errmsg("selected new timeline ID: %u", newTLI)));
6012
6013 /*
6014 * Make a writable copy of the last WAL segment. (Note that we also
6015 * have a copy of the last block of the old WAL in
6016 * endOfRecovery->lastPage; we will use that below.)
6017 */
6018 XLogInitNewTimeline(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
6019
6020 /*
6021 * Remove the signal files out of the way, so that we don't
6022 * accidentally re-enter archive recovery mode in a subsequent crash.
6023 */
6024 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->standby_signal_file_found)
6026
6027 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->recovery_signal_file_found)
6029
6030 /*
6031 * Write the timeline history file, and have it archived. After this
6032 * point (or rather, as soon as the file is archived), the timeline
6033 * will appear as "taken" in the WAL archive and to any standby
6034 * servers. If we crash before actually switching to the new
6035 * timeline, standby servers will nevertheless think that we switched
6036 * to the new timeline, and will try to connect to the new timeline.
6037 * To minimize the window for that, try to do as little as possible
6038 * between here and writing the end-of-recovery record.
6039 */
6041 EndOfLog, endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6042
6043 ereport(LOG,
6044 (errmsg("archive recovery complete")));
6045 }
6046
6047 /* Save the selected TimeLineID in shared memory, too */
6049 XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID = newTLI;
6050 XLogCtl->PrevTimeLineID = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI;
6052
6053 /*
6054 * Actually, if WAL ended in an incomplete record, skip the parts that
6055 * made it through and start writing after the portion that persisted.
6056 * (It's critical to first write an OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD message, which
6057 * we'll do as soon as we're open for writing new WAL.)
6058 */
6060 {
6061 /*
6062 * We should only have a missingContrecPtr if we're not switching to a
6063 * new timeline. When a timeline switch occurs, WAL is copied from the
6064 * old timeline to the new only up to the end of the last complete
6065 * record, so there can't be an incomplete WAL record that we need to
6066 * disregard.
6067 */
6068 Assert(newTLI == endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRecTLI);
6070 EndOfLog = missingContrecPtr;
6071 }
6072
6073 /*
6074 * Prepare to write WAL starting at EndOfLog location, and init xlog
6075 * buffer cache using the block containing the last record from the
6076 * previous incarnation.
6077 */
6078 Insert = &XLogCtl->Insert;
6079 Insert->PrevBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastRec);
6080 Insert->CurrBytePos = XLogRecPtrToBytePos(EndOfLog);
6081
6082 /*
6083 * Tricky point here: lastPage contains the *last* block that the LastRec
6084 * record spans, not the one it starts in. The last block is indeed the
6085 * one we want to use.
6086 */
6087 if (EndOfLog % XLOG_BLCKSZ != 0)
6088 {
6089 char *page;
6090 int len;
6091 int firstIdx;
6092
6093 firstIdx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(EndOfLog);
6094 len = EndOfLog - endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr;
6095 Assert(len < XLOG_BLCKSZ);
6096
6097 /* Copy the valid part of the last block, and zero the rest */
6098 page = &XLogCtl->pages[firstIdx * XLOG_BLCKSZ];
6099 memcpy(page, endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage, len);
6100 memset(page + len, 0, XLOG_BLCKSZ - len);
6101
6102 pg_atomic_write_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[firstIdx], endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ);
6103 XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPageBeginPtr + XLOG_BLCKSZ;
6104 }
6105 else
6106 {
6107 /*
6108 * There is no partial block to copy. Just set InitializedUpTo, and
6109 * let the first attempt to insert a log record to initialize the next
6110 * buffer.
6111 */
6112 XLogCtl->InitializedUpTo = EndOfLog;
6113 }
6114
6115 /*
6116 * Update local and shared status. This is OK to do without any locks
6117 * because no other process can be reading or writing WAL yet.
6118 */
6119 LogwrtResult.Write = LogwrtResult.Flush = EndOfLog;
6123 XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndOfLog;
6124 XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Flush = EndOfLog;
6125
6126 /*
6127 * Preallocate additional log files, if wanted.
6128 */
6129 PreallocXlogFiles(EndOfLog, newTLI);
6130
6131 /*
6132 * Okay, we're officially UP.
6133 */
6134 InRecovery = false;
6135
6136 /* start the archive_timeout timer and LSN running */
6137 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
6138 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchLSN = EndOfLog;
6139
6140 /* also initialize latestCompletedXid, to nextXid - 1 */
6141 LWLockAcquire(ProcArrayLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
6144 LWLockRelease(ProcArrayLock);
6145
6146 /*
6147 * Start up subtrans, if not already done for hot standby. (commit
6148 * timestamps are started below, if necessary.)
6149 */
6151 StartupSUBTRANS(oldestActiveXID);
6152
6153 /*
6154 * Perform end of recovery actions for any SLRUs that need it.
6155 */
6156 TrimCLOG();
6157 TrimMultiXact();
6158
6159 /*
6160 * Reload shared-memory state for prepared transactions. This needs to
6161 * happen before renaming the last partial segment of the old timeline as
6162 * it may be possible that we have to recover some transactions from it.
6163 */
6165
6166 /* Shut down xlogreader */
6168
6169 /* Enable WAL writes for this backend only. */
6171
6172 /* If necessary, write overwrite-contrecord before doing anything else */
6174 {
6177 }
6178
6179 /*
6180 * Update full_page_writes in shared memory and write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
6181 * record before resource manager writes cleanup WAL records or checkpoint
6182 * record is written.
6183 */
6184 Insert->fullPageWrites = lastFullPageWrites;
6186
6187 /*
6188 * Emit checkpoint or end-of-recovery record in XLOG, if required.
6189 */
6190 if (performedWalRecovery)
6191 promoted = PerformRecoveryXLogAction();
6192
6193 /*
6194 * If any of the critical GUCs have changed, log them before we allow
6195 * backends to write WAL.
6196 */
6198
6199 /* If this is archive recovery, perform post-recovery cleanup actions. */
6201 CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(EndOfLogTLI, EndOfLog, newTLI);
6202
6203 /*
6204 * Local WAL inserts enabled, so it's time to finish initialization of
6205 * commit timestamp.
6206 */
6208
6209 /* Clean up EndOfWalRecoveryInfo data to appease Valgrind leak checking */
6210 if (endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage)
6211 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->lastPage);
6212 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo->recoveryStopReason);
6213 pfree(endOfRecoveryInfo);
6214
6215 /*
6216 * All done with end-of-recovery actions.
6217 *
6218 * Now allow backends to write WAL and update the control file status in
6219 * consequence. SharedRecoveryState, that controls if backends can write
6220 * WAL, is updated while holding ControlFileLock to prevent other backends
6221 * to look at an inconsistent state of the control file in shared memory.
6222 * There is still a small window during which backends can write WAL and
6223 * the control file is still referring to a system not in DB_IN_PRODUCTION
6224 * state while looking at the on-disk control file.
6225 *
6226 * Also, we use info_lck to update SharedRecoveryState to ensure that
6227 * there are no race conditions concerning visibility of other recent
6228 * updates to shared memory.
6229 */
6230 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
6232
6236
6238 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
6239
6240 /*
6241 * Wake up all waiters for replay LSN. They need to report an error that
6242 * recovery was ended before reaching the target LSN.
6243 */
6245
6246 /*
6247 * Shutdown the recovery environment. This must occur after
6248 * RecoverPreparedTransactions() (see notes in lock_twophase_recover())
6249 * and after switching SharedRecoveryState to RECOVERY_STATE_DONE so as
6250 * any session building a snapshot will not rely on KnownAssignedXids as
6251 * RecoveryInProgress() would return false at this stage. This is
6252 * particularly critical for prepared 2PC transactions, that would still
6253 * need to be included in snapshots once recovery has ended.
6254 */
6257
6258 /*
6259 * If there were cascading standby servers connected to us, nudge any wal
6260 * sender processes to notice that we've been promoted.
6261 */
6262 WalSndWakeup(true, true);
6263
6264 /*
6265 * If this was a promotion, request an (online) checkpoint now. This isn't
6266 * required for consistency, but the last restartpoint might be far back,
6267 * and in case of a crash, recovering from it might take a longer than is
6268 * appropriate now that we're not in standby mode anymore.
6269 */
6270 if (promoted)
6272}
static void pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition: atomics.h:504
TimeLineID findNewestTimeLine(TimeLineID startTLI)
Definition: timeline.c:264
void restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(TimeLineID begin, TimeLineID end)
Definition: timeline.c:50
void writeTimeLineHistory(TimeLineID newTLI, TimeLineID parentTLI, XLogRecPtr switchpoint, char *reason)
Definition: timeline.c:304
void startup_progress_timeout_handler(void)
Definition: startup.c:303
uint32 TransactionId
Definition: c.h:671
void StartupCLOG(void)
Definition: clog.c:843
void TrimCLOG(void)
Definition: clog.c:858
void StartupCommitTs(void)
Definition: commit_ts.c:608
void CompleteCommitTsInitialization(void)
Definition: commit_ts.c:618
void SyncDataDirectory(void)
Definition: fd.c:3590
#define IsBootstrapProcessingMode()
Definition: miscadmin.h:477
void TrimMultiXact(void)
Definition: multixact.c:1831
void StartupMultiXact(void)
Definition: multixact.c:1806
void StartupReplicationOrigin(void)
Definition: origin.c:722
@ DB_IN_PRODUCTION
Definition: pg_control.h:97
@ DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY
Definition: pg_control.h:95
const void size_t len
void pgstat_restore_stats(void)
Definition: pgstat.c:507
void pgstat_discard_stats(void)
Definition: pgstat.c:519
void ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(RunningTransactions running)
Definition: procarray.c:1054
void ProcArrayInitRecovery(TransactionId initializedUptoXID)
Definition: procarray.c:1023
static void set_ps_display(const char *activity)
Definition: ps_status.h:40
void ResetUnloggedRelations(int op)
Definition: reinit.c:47
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT
Definition: reinit.h:28
#define UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP
Definition: reinit.h:27
void RelationCacheInitFileRemove(void)
Definition: relcache.c:6900
void StartupReorderBuffer(void)
void StartupReplicationSlots(void)
Definition: slot.c:2206
void DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles(void)
Definition: snapmgr.c:1587
void InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition: standby.c:95
void ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(void)
Definition: standby.c:161
@ SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS
Definition: standby.h:82
XLogRecPtr lastPageBeginPtr
Definition: xlogrecovery.h:121
XLogRecPtr abortedRecPtr
Definition: xlogrecovery.h:130
XLogRecPtr missingContrecPtr
Definition: xlogrecovery.h:131
TimeLineID endOfLogTLI
Definition: xlogrecovery.h:119
TransactionId oldestRunningXid
Definition: standby.h:92
TransactionId nextXid
Definition: standby.h:91
TransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition: standby.h:95
subxids_array_status subxid_status
Definition: standby.h:90
TransactionId * xids
Definition: standby.h:97
FullTransactionId latestCompletedXid
Definition: transam.h:238
pg_atomic_uint64 logInsertResult
Definition: xlog.c:472
void StartupSUBTRANS(TransactionId oldestActiveXID)
Definition: subtrans.c:283
TimeoutId RegisterTimeout(TimeoutId id, timeout_handler_proc handler)
Definition: timeout.c:505
@ STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT
Definition: timeout.h:38
#define TransactionIdRetreat(dest)
Definition: transam.h:141
static void FullTransactionIdRetreat(FullTransactionId *dest)
Definition: transam.h:103
#define XidFromFullTransactionId(x)
Definition: transam.h:48
#define TransactionIdIsValid(xid)
Definition: transam.h:41
#define TransactionIdIsNormal(xid)
Definition: transam.h:42
void RecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition: twophase.c:2083
void restoreTwoPhaseData(void)
Definition: twophase.c:1904
TransactionId PrescanPreparedTransactions(TransactionId **xids_p, int *nxids_p)
Definition: twophase.c:1966
void StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(void)
Definition: twophase.c:2045
void WalSndWakeup(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition: walsender.c:3793
void UpdateFullPageWrites(void)
Definition: xlog.c:8234
static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4120
static XLogRecPtr CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(XLogRecPtr aborted_lsn, XLogRecPtr pagePtr, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition: xlog.c:7507
static void XLogReportParameters(void)
Definition: xlog.c:8171
static bool PerformRecoveryXLogAction(void)
Definition: xlog.c:6354
static void CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(TimeLineID EndOfLogTLI, XLogRecPtr EndOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition: xlog.c:5341
static bool lastFullPageWrites
Definition: xlog.c:219
static void XLogInitNewTimeline(TimeLineID endTLI, XLogRecPtr endOfLog, TimeLineID newTLI)
Definition: xlog.c:5266
static void CheckRequiredParameterValues(void)
Definition: xlog.c:5437
static void RemoveTempXlogFiles(void)
Definition: xlog.c:3853
static char * str_time(pg_time_t tnow, char *buf, size_t bufsize)
Definition: xlog.c:5253
#define TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD
Definition: xlog.h:309
#define TABLESPACE_MAP
Definition: xlog.h:308
#define STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition: xlog.h:304
#define BACKUP_LABEL_OLD
Definition: xlog.h:306
#define BACKUP_LABEL_FILE
Definition: xlog.h:305
#define RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE
Definition: xlog.h:303
@ RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH
Definition: xlog.h:91
@ RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE
Definition: xlog.h:92
#define XRecOffIsValid(xlrp)
void ShutdownWalRecovery(void)
bool InArchiveRecovery
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:141
void PerformWalRecovery(void)
static XLogRecPtr missingContrecPtr
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:381
static XLogRecPtr abortedRecPtr
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:380
EndOfWalRecoveryInfo * FinishWalRecovery(void)
void InitWalRecovery(ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool *wasShutdown_ptr, bool *haveBackupLabel_ptr, bool *haveTblspcMap_ptr)
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:520
TimeLineID recoveryTargetTLI
Definition: xlogrecovery.c:125
HotStandbyState standbyState
Definition: xlogutils.c:53
bool InRecovery
Definition: xlogutils.c:50
@ STANDBY_DISABLED
Definition: xlogutils.h:52
void WaitLSNWakeup(WaitLSNType lsnType, XLogRecPtr currentLSN)
Definition: xlogwait.c:269
@ WAIT_LSN_TYPE_REPLAY
Definition: xlogwait.h:38

References abortedRecPtr, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::abortedRecPtr, AdvanceOldestClogXid(), ArchiveRecoveryRequested, Assert(), AuxProcessResourceOwner, BACKUP_LABEL_FILE, BACKUP_LABEL_OLD, ControlFileData::backupEndRequired, ControlFileData::backupStartPoint, ControlFileData::checkPoint, CHECKPOINT_FORCE, ControlFileData::checkPointCopy, CheckRequiredParameterValues(), CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(), CompleteCommitTsInitialization(), ControlFile, CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(), CurrentResourceOwner, DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, DB_IN_CRASH_RECOVERY, DB_IN_PRODUCTION, DB_SHUTDOWNED, DB_SHUTDOWNED_IN_RECOVERY, DB_SHUTDOWNING, DEBUG1, DeleteAllExportedSnapshotFiles(), doPageWrites, durable_rename(), durable_unlink(), EnableHotStandby, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::endOfLog, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::endOfLogTLI, ereport, errcode(), ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED, errhint(), errmsg(), errmsg_internal(), FATAL, findNewestTimeLine(), FinishWalRecovery(), FirstNormalUnloggedLSN, XLogwrtRqst::Flush, XLogwrtResult::Flush, CheckPoint::fullPageWrites, FullTransactionIdRetreat(), InArchiveRecovery, XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::InitializedUpTo, InitRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(), InitWalRecovery(), InRecovery, XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, InvalidXLogRecPtr, IsBootstrapProcessingMode, IsPostmasterEnvironment, lastFullPageWrites, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::lastPage, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::lastPageBeginPtr, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::lastRec, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::lastRecTLI, XLogCtlData::lastSegSwitchLSN, XLogCtlData::lastSegSwitchTime, TransamVariablesData::latestCompletedXid, RunningTransactionsData::latestCompletedXid, len, LocalMinRecoveryPoint, LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI, LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(), LOG, XLogCtlData::logFlushResult, XLogCtlData::logInsertResult, XLogCtlData::logWriteResult, LogwrtResult, XLogCtlData::LogwrtRqst, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, missingContrecPtr, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::missingContrecPtr, MultiXactSetNextMXact(), CheckPoint::newestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::nextMulti, CheckPoint::nextMultiOffset, TransamVariablesData::nextOid, CheckPoint::nextOid, TransamVariablesData::nextXid, CheckPoint::nextXid, RunningTransactionsData::nextXid, NOTICE, TransamVariablesData::oidCount, CheckPoint::oldestActiveXid, CheckPoint::oldestCommitTsXid, CheckPoint::oldestMulti, CheckPoint::oldestMultiDB, RunningTransactionsData::oldestRunningXid, CheckPoint::oldestXid, CheckPoint::oldestXidDB, XLogCtlData::pages, PerformRecoveryXLogAction(), PerformWalRecovery(), pfree(), pg_atomic_write_membarrier_u64(), pg_atomic_write_u64(), pg_usleep(), pgstat_discard_stats(), pgstat_restore_stats(), PreallocXlogFiles(), PrescanPreparedTransactions(), XLogCtlData::PrevTimeLineID, ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(), ProcArrayInitRecovery(), RecoverPreparedTransactions(), RECOVERY_SIGNAL_FILE, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::recovery_signal_file_found, RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE, RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH, RECOVERY_STATE_DONE, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::recoveryStopReason, recoveryTargetTLI, CheckPoint::redo, RedoRecPtr, XLogCtlInsert::RedoRecPtr, XLogCtlData::RedoRecPtr, RegisterTimeout(), RelationCacheInitFileRemove(), RemoveTempXlogFiles(), RequestCheckpoint(), ResetUnloggedRelations(), restoreTimeLineHistoryFiles(), restoreTwoPhaseData(), set_ps_display(), SetCommitTsLimit(), SetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(), SetMultiXactIdLimit(), SetTransactionIdLimit(), XLogCtlData::SharedRecoveryState, ShutdownRecoveryTransactionEnvironment(), ShutdownWalRecovery(), SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, STANDBY_DISABLED, STANDBY_SIGNAL_FILE, EndOfWalRecoveryInfo::standby_signal_file_found, StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(), standbyState, STARTUP_PROGRESS_TIMEOUT, startup_progress_timeout_handler(), StartupCLOG(), StartupCommitTs(), StartupMultiXact(), StartupReorderBuffer(), StartupReplicationOrigin(), StartupReplicationSlots(), StartupSUBTRANS(), ControlFileData::state, str_time(), RunningTransactionsData::subxcnt, RunningTransactionsData::subxid_status, SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS, SyncDataDirectory(), TABLESPACE_MAP, TABLESPACE_MAP_OLD, CheckPoint::ThisTimeLineID, CheckPoint::time, ControlFileData::time, ControlFileData::track_commit_timestamp, TransactionIdIsNormal, TransactionIdIsValid, TransactionIdRetreat, TransamVariables, TrimCLOG(), TrimMultiXact(), UNLOGGED_RELATION_CLEANUP, UNLOGGED_RELATION_INIT, XLogCtlData::unloggedLSN, ControlFileData::unloggedLSN, UpdateControlFile(), UpdateFullPageWrites(), ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure(), WAIT_LSN_TYPE_REPLAY, WaitLSNWakeup(), WalSndWakeup(), XLogwrtRqst::Write, XLogwrtResult::Write, writeTimeLineHistory(), RunningTransactionsData::xcnt, XidFromFullTransactionId, RunningTransactionsData::xids, XLogCtlData::xlblocks, XLogCtl, XLogInitNewTimeline(), XLogRecPtrIsValid, XLogRecPtrToBufIdx, XLogRecPtrToBytePos(), XLogReportParameters(), and XRecOffIsValid.

Referenced by InitPostgres(), and StartupProcessMain().

◆ str_time()

static char * str_time ( pg_time_t  tnow,
char *  buf,
size_t  bufsize 
)
static

Definition at line 5253 of file xlog.c.

5254{
5256 "%Y-%m-%d %H:%M:%S %Z",
5257 pg_localtime(&tnow, log_timezone));
5258
5259 return buf;
5260}
#define bufsize
Definition: indent_globs.h:36
static char buf[DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE]
Definition: pg_test_fsync.c:71
size_t pg_strftime(char *s, size_t maxsize, const char *format, const struct pg_tm *t)
Definition: strftime.c:128
struct pg_tm * pg_localtime(const pg_time_t *timep, const pg_tz *tz)
Definition: localtime.c:1345
PGDLLIMPORT pg_tz * log_timezone
Definition: pgtz.c:31

References buf, bufsize, log_timezone, pg_localtime(), and pg_strftime().

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery()

void SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery ( XLogRecPtr  EndRecPtr,
TimeLineID  replayTLI 
)

Definition at line 6279 of file xlog.c.

6280{
6281 /* initialize minRecoveryPoint to this record */
6282 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
6284 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < EndRecPtr)
6285 {
6286 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = EndRecPtr;
6287 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
6288 }
6289 /* update local copy */
6292
6293 /*
6294 * The startup process can update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint from
6295 * this point.
6296 */
6298
6300
6301 /*
6302 * We update SharedRecoveryState while holding the lock on ControlFileLock
6303 * so both states are consistent in shared memory.
6304 */
6308
6309 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
6310}
static bool updateMinRecoveryPoint
Definition: xlog.c:649

References ControlFile, DB_IN_ARCHIVE_RECOVERY, XLogCtlData::info_lck, LocalMinRecoveryPoint, LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, RECOVERY_STATE_ARCHIVE, XLogCtlData::SharedRecoveryState, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, ControlFileData::state, UpdateControlFile(), updateMinRecoveryPoint, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by ReadRecord().

◆ update_checkpoint_display()

static void update_checkpoint_display ( int  flags,
bool  restartpoint,
bool  reset 
)
static

Definition at line 6894 of file xlog.c.

6895{
6896 /*
6897 * The status is reported only for end-of-recovery and shutdown
6898 * checkpoints or shutdown restartpoints. Updating the ps display is
6899 * useful in those situations as it may not be possible to rely on
6900 * pg_stat_activity to see the status of the checkpointer or the startup
6901 * process.
6902 */
6904 return;
6905
6906 if (reset)
6907 set_ps_display("");
6908 else
6909 {
6910 char activitymsg[128];
6911
6912 snprintf(activitymsg, sizeof(activitymsg), "performing %s%s%s",
6913 (flags & CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY) ? "end-of-recovery " : "",
6914 (flags & CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN) ? "shutdown " : "",
6915 restartpoint ? "restartpoint" : "checkpoint");
6916 set_ps_display(activitymsg);
6917 }
6918}

References CHECKPOINT_END_OF_RECOVERY, CHECKPOINT_IS_SHUTDOWN, reset(), set_ps_display(), and snprintf.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), and CreateRestartPoint().

◆ UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate()

static void UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate ( uint64  nbytes)
static

Definition at line 6856 of file xlog.c.

6857{
6858 /*
6859 * To estimate the number of segments consumed between checkpoints, keep a
6860 * moving average of the amount of WAL generated in previous checkpoint
6861 * cycles. However, if the load is bursty, with quiet periods and busy
6862 * periods, we want to cater for the peak load. So instead of a plain
6863 * moving average, let the average decline slowly if the previous cycle
6864 * used less WAL than estimated, but bump it up immediately if it used
6865 * more.
6866 *
6867 * When checkpoints are triggered by max_wal_size, this should converge to
6868 * CheckpointSegments * wal_segment_size,
6869 *
6870 * Note: This doesn't pay any attention to what caused the checkpoint.
6871 * Checkpoints triggered manually with CHECKPOINT command, or by e.g.
6872 * starting a base backup, are counted the same as those created
6873 * automatically. The slow-decline will largely mask them out, if they are
6874 * not frequent. If they are frequent, it seems reasonable to count them
6875 * in as any others; if you issue a manual checkpoint every 5 minutes and
6876 * never let a timed checkpoint happen, it makes sense to base the
6877 * preallocation on that 5 minute interval rather than whatever
6878 * checkpoint_timeout is set to.
6879 */
6880 PrevCheckPointDistance = nbytes;
6881 if (CheckPointDistanceEstimate < nbytes)
6883 else
6885 (0.90 * CheckPointDistanceEstimate + 0.10 * (double) nbytes);
6886}

References CheckPointDistanceEstimate, and PrevCheckPointDistance.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), and CreateRestartPoint().

◆ UpdateControlFile()

static void UpdateControlFile ( void  )
static

Definition at line 4602 of file xlog.c.

4603{
4605}
void update_controlfile(const char *DataDir, ControlFileData *ControlFile, bool do_sync)

References ControlFile, DataDir, and update_controlfile().

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(), CreateRestartPoint(), ReachedEndOfBackup(), StartupXLOG(), SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(), UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(), xlog_redo(), and XLogReportParameters().

◆ UpdateFullPageWrites()

void UpdateFullPageWrites ( void  )

Definition at line 8234 of file xlog.c.

8235{
8237 bool recoveryInProgress;
8238
8239 /*
8240 * Do nothing if full_page_writes has not been changed.
8241 *
8242 * It's safe to check the shared full_page_writes without the lock,
8243 * because we assume that there is no concurrently running process which
8244 * can update it.
8245 */
8246 if (fullPageWrites == Insert->fullPageWrites)
8247 return;
8248
8249 /*
8250 * Perform this outside critical section so that the WAL insert
8251 * initialization done by RecoveryInProgress() doesn't trigger an
8252 * assertion failure.
8253 */
8254 recoveryInProgress = RecoveryInProgress();
8255
8257
8258 /*
8259 * It's always safe to take full page images, even when not strictly
8260 * required, but not the other round. So if we're setting full_page_writes
8261 * to true, first set it true and then write the WAL record. If we're
8262 * setting it to false, first write the WAL record and then set the global
8263 * flag.
8264 */
8265 if (fullPageWrites)
8266 {
8268 Insert->fullPageWrites = true;
8270 }
8271
8272 /*
8273 * Write an XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record. This allows us to keep track of
8274 * full_page_writes during archive recovery, if required.
8275 */
8276 if (XLogStandbyInfoActive() && !recoveryInProgress)
8277 {
8279 XLogRegisterData(&fullPageWrites, sizeof(bool));
8280
8281 XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_FPW_CHANGE);
8282 }
8283
8284 if (!fullPageWrites)
8285 {
8287 Insert->fullPageWrites = false;
8289 }
8291}
#define XLOG_FPW_CHANGE
Definition: pg_control.h:76

References END_CRIT_SECTION, fullPageWrites, XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), RecoveryInProgress(), START_CRIT_SECTION, WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), XLOG_FPW_CHANGE, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogCtl, XLogInsert(), XLogRegisterData(), and XLogStandbyInfoActive.

Referenced by StartupXLOG(), and UpdateSharedMemoryConfig().

◆ UpdateLastRemovedPtr()

static void UpdateLastRemovedPtr ( char *  filename)
static

Definition at line 3833 of file xlog.c.

3834{
3835 uint32 tli;
3836 XLogSegNo segno;
3837
3839
3841 if (segno > XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo)
3842 XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo = segno;
3844}
static void XLogFromFileName(const char *fname, TimeLineID *tli, XLogSegNo *logSegNo, int wal_segsz_bytes)

References filename, XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::lastRemovedSegNo, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, wal_segment_size, XLogCtl, and XLogFromFileName().

Referenced by RemoveOldXlogFiles().

◆ UpdateMinRecoveryPoint()

static void UpdateMinRecoveryPoint ( XLogRecPtr  lsn,
bool  force 
)
static

Definition at line 2703 of file xlog.c.

2704{
2705 /* Quick check using our local copy of the variable */
2706 if (!updateMinRecoveryPoint || (!force && lsn <= LocalMinRecoveryPoint))
2707 return;
2708
2709 /*
2710 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the WAL,
2711 * i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control file's
2712 * value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks here too. The
2713 * local values of minRecoveryPoint and minRecoveryPointTLI should not be
2714 * updated until crash recovery finishes. We only do this for the startup
2715 * process as it should not update its own reference of minRecoveryPoint
2716 * until it has finished crash recovery to make sure that all WAL
2717 * available is replayed in this case. This also saves from extra locks
2718 * taken on the control file from the startup process.
2719 */
2721 {
2722 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2723 return;
2724 }
2725
2726 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
2727
2728 /* update local copy */
2731
2733 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
2734 else if (force || LocalMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2735 {
2736 XLogRecPtr newMinRecoveryPoint;
2737 TimeLineID newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
2738
2739 /*
2740 * To avoid having to update the control file too often, we update it
2741 * all the way to the last record being replayed, even though 'lsn'
2742 * would suffice for correctness. This also allows the 'force' case
2743 * to not need a valid 'lsn' value.
2744 *
2745 * Another important reason for doing it this way is that the passed
2746 * 'lsn' value could be bogus, i.e., past the end of available WAL, if
2747 * the caller got it from a corrupted heap page. Accepting such a
2748 * value as the min recovery point would prevent us from coming up at
2749 * all. Instead, we just log a warning and continue with recovery.
2750 * (See also the comments about corrupt LSNs in XLogFlush.)
2751 */
2752 newMinRecoveryPoint = GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&newMinRecoveryPointTLI);
2753 if (!force && newMinRecoveryPoint < lsn)
2754 elog(WARNING,
2755 "xlog min recovery request %X/%08X is past current point %X/%08X",
2756 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(lsn), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint));
2757
2758 /* update control file */
2759 if (ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint < newMinRecoveryPoint)
2760 {
2761 ControlFile->minRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
2762 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
2764 LocalMinRecoveryPoint = newMinRecoveryPoint;
2765 LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI = newMinRecoveryPointTLI;
2766
2768 errmsg_internal("updated min recovery point to %X/%08X on timeline %u",
2769 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(newMinRecoveryPoint),
2770 newMinRecoveryPointTLI));
2771 }
2772 }
2773 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
2774}
XLogRecPtr GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(TimeLineID *replayEndTLI)

References ControlFile, DEBUG2, elog, ereport, errmsg_internal(), GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(), InRecovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint, LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, UpdateControlFile(), updateMinRecoveryPoint, WARNING, and XLogRecPtrIsValid.

Referenced by CreateRestartPoint(), XLogFlush(), and XLogInitNewTimeline().

◆ ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure()

static void ValidateXLOGDirectoryStructure ( void  )
static

Definition at line 4120 of file xlog.c.

4121{
4122 char path[MAXPGPATH];
4123 struct stat stat_buf;
4124
4125 /* Check for pg_wal; if it doesn't exist, error out */
4126 if (stat(XLOGDIR, &stat_buf) != 0 ||
4127 !S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4128 ereport(FATAL,
4130 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4131 XLOGDIR)));
4132
4133 /* Check for archive_status */
4134 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/archive_status");
4135 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4136 {
4137 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4138 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4139 ereport(FATAL,
4141 errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4142 path)));
4143 }
4144 else
4145 {
4146 ereport(LOG,
4147 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4148 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4149 ereport(FATAL,
4151 errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4152 path)));
4153 }
4154
4155 /* Check for summaries */
4156 snprintf(path, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/summaries");
4157 if (stat(path, &stat_buf) == 0)
4158 {
4159 /* Check for weird cases where it exists but isn't a directory */
4160 if (!S_ISDIR(stat_buf.st_mode))
4161 ereport(FATAL,
4162 (errmsg("required WAL directory \"%s\" does not exist",
4163 path)));
4164 }
4165 else
4166 {
4167 ereport(LOG,
4168 (errmsg("creating missing WAL directory \"%s\"", path)));
4169 if (MakePGDirectory(path) < 0)
4170 ereport(FATAL,
4171 (errmsg("could not create missing directory \"%s\": %m",
4172 path)));
4173 }
4174}
int MakePGDirectory(const char *directoryName)
Definition: fd.c:3959
#define S_ISDIR(m)
Definition: win32_port.h:315

References ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), FATAL, LOG, MakePGDirectory(), MAXPGPATH, S_ISDIR, snprintf, stat::st_mode, stat, and XLOGDIR.

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish()

static XLogRecPtr WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish ( XLogRecPtr  upto)
static

Definition at line 1510 of file xlog.c.

1511{
1512 uint64 bytepos;
1513 XLogRecPtr inserted;
1514 XLogRecPtr reservedUpto;
1515 XLogRecPtr finishedUpto;
1517 int i;
1518
1519 if (MyProc == NULL)
1520 elog(PANIC, "cannot wait without a PGPROC structure");
1521
1522 /*
1523 * Check if there's any work to do. Use a barrier to ensure we get the
1524 * freshest value.
1525 */
1527 if (upto <= inserted)
1528 return inserted;
1529
1530 /* Read the current insert position */
1531 SpinLockAcquire(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1532 bytepos = Insert->CurrBytePos;
1533 SpinLockRelease(&Insert->insertpos_lck);
1534 reservedUpto = XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(bytepos);
1535
1536 /*
1537 * No-one should request to flush a piece of WAL that hasn't even been
1538 * reserved yet. However, it can happen if there is a block with a bogus
1539 * LSN on disk, for example. XLogFlush checks for that situation and
1540 * complains, but only after the flush. Here we just assume that to mean
1541 * that all WAL that has been reserved needs to be finished. In this
1542 * corner-case, the return value can be smaller than 'upto' argument.
1543 */
1544 if (upto > reservedUpto)
1545 {
1546 ereport(LOG,
1547 errmsg("request to flush past end of generated WAL; request %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1548 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(upto), LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(reservedUpto)));
1549 upto = reservedUpto;
1550 }
1551
1552 /*
1553 * Loop through all the locks, sleeping on any in-progress insert older
1554 * than 'upto'.
1555 *
1556 * finishedUpto is our return value, indicating the point upto which all
1557 * the WAL insertions have been finished. Initialize it to the head of
1558 * reserved WAL, and as we iterate through the insertion locks, back it
1559 * out for any insertion that's still in progress.
1560 */
1561 finishedUpto = reservedUpto;
1562 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1563 {
1564 XLogRecPtr insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
1565
1566 do
1567 {
1568 /*
1569 * See if this insertion is in progress. LWLockWaitForVar will
1570 * wait for the lock to be released, or for the 'value' to be set
1571 * by a LWLockUpdateVar call. When a lock is initially acquired,
1572 * its value is 0 (InvalidXLogRecPtr), which means that we don't
1573 * know where it's inserting yet. We will have to wait for it. If
1574 * it's a small insertion, the record will most likely fit on the
1575 * same page and the inserter will release the lock without ever
1576 * calling LWLockUpdateVar. But if it has to sleep, it will
1577 * advertise the insertion point with LWLockUpdateVar before
1578 * sleeping.
1579 *
1580 * In this loop we are only waiting for insertions that started
1581 * before WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish was called. The lack of
1582 * memory barriers in the loop means that we might see locks as
1583 * "unused" that have since become used. This is fine because
1584 * they only can be used for later insertions that we would not
1585 * want to wait on anyway. Not taking a lock to acquire the
1586 * current insertingAt value means that we might see older
1587 * insertingAt values. This is also fine, because if we read a
1588 * value too old, we will add ourselves to the wait queue, which
1589 * contains atomic operations.
1590 */
1591 if (LWLockWaitForVar(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock,
1593 insertingat, &insertingat))
1594 {
1595 /* the lock was free, so no insertion in progress */
1596 insertingat = InvalidXLogRecPtr;
1597 break;
1598 }
1599
1600 /*
1601 * This insertion is still in progress. Have to wait, unless the
1602 * inserter has proceeded past 'upto'.
1603 */
1604 } while (insertingat < upto);
1605
1606 if (XLogRecPtrIsValid(insertingat) && insertingat < finishedUpto)
1607 finishedUpto = insertingat;
1608 }
1609
1610 /*
1611 * Advance the limit we know to have been inserted and return the freshest
1612 * value we know of, which might be beyond what we requested if somebody
1613 * is concurrently doing this with an 'upto' pointer ahead of us.
1614 */
1616 finishedUpto);
1617
1618 return finishedUpto;
1619}
static uint64 pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 target)
Definition: atomics.h:595
bool LWLockWaitForVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 oldval, uint64 *newval)
Definition: lwlock.c:1590
PGPROC * MyProc
Definition: proc.c:67
pg_atomic_uint64 insertingAt
Definition: xlog.c:372

References elog, ereport, errmsg(), i, XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), WALInsertLock::insertingAt, InvalidXLogRecPtr, WALInsertLockPadded::l, LOG, XLogCtlData::logInsertResult, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, LWLockWaitForVar(), MyProc, NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, PANIC, pg_atomic_monotonic_advance_u64(), pg_atomic_read_membarrier_u64(), SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, WALInsertLocks, XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(), XLogCtl, and XLogRecPtrIsValid.

Referenced by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), XLogBackgroundFlush(), and XLogFlush().

◆ WALInsertLockAcquire()

static void WALInsertLockAcquire ( void  )
static

Definition at line 1377 of file xlog.c.

1378{
1379 bool immed;
1380
1381 /*
1382 * It doesn't matter which of the WAL insertion locks we acquire, so try
1383 * the one we used last time. If the system isn't particularly busy, it's
1384 * a good bet that it's still available, and it's good to have some
1385 * affinity to a particular lock so that you don't unnecessarily bounce
1386 * cache lines between processes when there's no contention.
1387 *
1388 * If this is the first time through in this backend, pick a lock
1389 * (semi-)randomly. This allows the locks to be used evenly if you have a
1390 * lot of very short connections.
1391 */
1392 static int lockToTry = -1;
1393
1394 if (lockToTry == -1)
1395 lockToTry = MyProcNumber % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
1396 MyLockNo = lockToTry;
1397
1398 /*
1399 * The insertingAt value is initially set to 0, as we don't know our
1400 * insert location yet.
1401 */
1403 if (!immed)
1404 {
1405 /*
1406 * If we couldn't get the lock immediately, try another lock next
1407 * time. On a system with more insertion locks than concurrent
1408 * inserters, this causes all the inserters to eventually migrate to a
1409 * lock that no-one else is using. On a system with more inserters
1410 * than locks, it still helps to distribute the inserters evenly
1411 * across the locks.
1412 */
1413 lockToTry = (lockToTry + 1) % NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
1414 }
1415}
ProcNumber MyProcNumber
Definition: globals.c:90
static int MyLockNo
Definition: xlog.c:652

References LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), MyLockNo, MyProcNumber, NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, and WALInsertLocks.

Referenced by CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(), and XLogInsertRecord().

◆ WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive()

static void WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive ( void  )
static

Definition at line 1422 of file xlog.c.

1423{
1424 int i;
1425
1426 /*
1427 * When holding all the locks, all but the last lock's insertingAt
1428 * indicator is set to 0xFFFFFFFFFFFFFFFF, which is higher than any real
1429 * XLogRecPtr value, to make sure that no-one blocks waiting on those.
1430 */
1431 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS - 1; i++)
1432 {
1437 }
1438 /* Variable value reset to 0 at release */
1440
1441 holdingAllLocks = true;
1442}
#define PG_UINT64_MAX
Definition: c.h:612
void LWLockUpdateVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition: lwlock.c:1726
static bool holdingAllLocks
Definition: xlog.c:653

References holdingAllLocks, i, WALInsertLock::insertingAt, WALInsertLockPadded::l, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockUpdateVar(), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, PG_UINT64_MAX, and WALInsertLocks.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(), CreateRestartPoint(), do_pg_abort_backup(), do_pg_backup_start(), do_pg_backup_stop(), UpdateFullPageWrites(), and XLogInsertRecord().

◆ WALInsertLockRelease()

static void WALInsertLockRelease ( void  )
static

Definition at line 1451 of file xlog.c.

1452{
1453 if (holdingAllLocks)
1454 {
1455 int i;
1456
1457 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
1460 0);
1461
1462 holdingAllLocks = false;
1463 }
1464 else
1465 {
1468 0);
1469 }
1470}
void LWLockReleaseClearVar(LWLock *lock, pg_atomic_uint64 *valptr, uint64 val)
Definition: lwlock.c:1923

References holdingAllLocks, i, WALInsertLock::insertingAt, WALInsertLockPadded::l, LWLockReleaseClearVar(), MyLockNo, NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, and WALInsertLocks.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(), CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(), CreateRestartPoint(), do_pg_abort_backup(), do_pg_backup_start(), do_pg_backup_stop(), UpdateFullPageWrites(), and XLogInsertRecord().

◆ WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt()

static void WALInsertLockUpdateInsertingAt ( XLogRecPtr  insertingAt)
static

Definition at line 1477 of file xlog.c.

1478{
1479 if (holdingAllLocks)
1480 {
1481 /*
1482 * We use the last lock to mark our actual position, see comments in
1483 * WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive.
1484 */
1487 insertingAt);
1488 }
1489 else
1492 insertingAt);
1493}

References holdingAllLocks, WALInsertLock::insertingAt, WALInsertLockPadded::l, LWLockUpdateVar(), MyLockNo, NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, and WALInsertLocks.

Referenced by GetXLogBuffer().

◆ WALReadFromBuffers()

Size WALReadFromBuffers ( char *  dstbuf,
XLogRecPtr  startptr,
Size  count,
TimeLineID  tli 
)

Definition at line 1754 of file xlog.c.

1756{
1757 char *pdst = dstbuf;
1758 XLogRecPtr recptr = startptr;
1759 XLogRecPtr inserted;
1760 Size nbytes = count;
1761
1763 return 0;
1764
1765 Assert(XLogRecPtrIsValid(startptr));
1766
1767 /*
1768 * Caller should ensure that the requested data has been inserted into WAL
1769 * buffers before we try to read it.
1770 */
1772 if (startptr + count > inserted)
1773 ereport(ERROR,
1774 errmsg("cannot read past end of generated WAL: requested %X/%08X, current position %X/%08X",
1775 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(startptr + count),
1776 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(inserted)));
1777
1778 /*
1779 * Loop through the buffers without a lock. For each buffer, atomically
1780 * read and verify the end pointer, then copy the data out, and finally
1781 * re-read and re-verify the end pointer.
1782 *
1783 * Once a page is evicted, it never returns to the WAL buffers, so if the
1784 * end pointer matches the expected end pointer before and after we copy
1785 * the data, then the right page must have been present during the data
1786 * copy. Read barriers are necessary to ensure that the data copy actually
1787 * happens between the two verification steps.
1788 *
1789 * If either verification fails, we simply terminate the loop and return
1790 * with the data that had been already copied out successfully.
1791 */
1792 while (nbytes > 0)
1793 {
1794 uint32 offset = recptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1795 int idx = XLogRecPtrToBufIdx(recptr);
1796 XLogRecPtr expectedEndPtr;
1797 XLogRecPtr endptr;
1798 const char *page;
1799 const char *psrc;
1800 Size npagebytes;
1801
1802 /*
1803 * Calculate the end pointer we expect in the xlblocks array if the
1804 * correct page is present.
1805 */
1806 expectedEndPtr = recptr + (XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1807
1808 /*
1809 * First verification step: check that the correct page is present in
1810 * the WAL buffers.
1811 */
1813 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1814 break;
1815
1816 /*
1817 * The correct page is present (or was at the time the endptr was
1818 * read; must re-verify later). Calculate pointer to source data and
1819 * determine how much data to read from this page.
1820 */
1821 page = XLogCtl->pages + idx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1822 psrc = page + offset;
1823 npagebytes = Min(nbytes, XLOG_BLCKSZ - offset);
1824
1825 /*
1826 * Ensure that the data copy and the first verification step are not
1827 * reordered.
1828 */
1830
1831 /* data copy */
1832 memcpy(pdst, psrc, npagebytes);
1833
1834 /*
1835 * Ensure that the data copy and the second verification step are not
1836 * reordered.
1837 */
1839
1840 /*
1841 * Second verification step: check that the page we read from wasn't
1842 * evicted while we were copying the data.
1843 */
1845 if (expectedEndPtr != endptr)
1846 break;
1847
1848 pdst += npagebytes;
1849 recptr += npagebytes;
1850 nbytes -= npagebytes;
1851 }
1852
1853 Assert(pdst - dstbuf <= count);
1854
1855 return pdst - dstbuf;
1856}
#define pg_read_barrier()
Definition: atomics.h:154
#define Min(x, y)
Definition: c.h:1016
TimeLineID GetWALInsertionTimeLine(void)
Definition: xlog.c:6590

References Assert(), ereport, errmsg(), ERROR, GetWALInsertionTimeLine(), idx(), XLogCtlData::logInsertResult, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, Min, XLogCtlData::pages, pg_atomic_read_u64(), pg_read_barrier, RecoveryInProgress(), XLogCtlData::xlblocks, XLogCtl, XLogRecPtrIsValid, and XLogRecPtrToBufIdx.

Referenced by XLogSendPhysical().

◆ WriteControlFile()

static void WriteControlFile ( void  )
static

Definition at line 4260 of file xlog.c.

4261{
4262 int fd;
4263 char buffer[PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE]; /* need not be aligned */
4264
4265 /*
4266 * Initialize version and compatibility-check fields
4267 */
4270
4271 ControlFile->maxAlign = MAXIMUM_ALIGNOF;
4273
4274 ControlFile->blcksz = BLCKSZ;
4275 ControlFile->relseg_size = RELSEG_SIZE;
4277 ControlFile->xlog_blcksz = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
4279
4282
4285
4286 ControlFile->float8ByVal = true; /* vestigial */
4287
4288 /*
4289 * Initialize the default 'char' signedness.
4290 *
4291 * The signedness of the char type is implementation-defined. For instance
4292 * on x86 architecture CPUs, the char data type is typically treated as
4293 * signed by default, whereas on aarch architecture CPUs, it is typically
4294 * treated as unsigned by default. In v17 or earlier, we accidentally let
4295 * C implementation signedness affect persistent data. This led to
4296 * inconsistent results when comparing char data across different
4297 * platforms.
4298 *
4299 * This flag can be used as a hint to ensure consistent behavior for
4300 * pre-v18 data files that store data sorted by the 'char' type on disk,
4301 * especially in cross-platform replication scenarios.
4302 *
4303 * Newly created database clusters unconditionally set the default char
4304 * signedness to true. pg_upgrade changes this flag for clusters that were
4305 * initialized on signedness=false platforms. As a result,
4306 * signedness=false setting will become rare over time. If we had known
4307 * about this problem during the last development cycle that forced initdb
4308 * (v8.3), we would have made all clusters signed or all clusters
4309 * unsigned. Making pg_upgrade the only source of signedness=false will
4310 * cause the population of database clusters to converge toward that
4311 * retrospective ideal.
4312 */
4314
4315 /* Contents are protected with a CRC */
4319 offsetof(ControlFileData, crc));
4321
4322 /*
4323 * We write out PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE bytes into pg_control, zero-padding
4324 * the excess over sizeof(ControlFileData). This reduces the odds of
4325 * premature-EOF errors when reading pg_control. We'll still fail when we
4326 * check the contents of the file, but hopefully with a more specific
4327 * error than "couldn't read pg_control".
4328 */
4329 memset(buffer, 0, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE);
4330 memcpy(buffer, ControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
4331
4333 O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
4334 if (fd < 0)
4335 ereport(PANIC,
4337 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m",
4339
4340 errno = 0;
4341 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_WRITE);
4343 {
4344 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
4345 if (errno == 0)
4346 errno = ENOSPC;
4347 ereport(PANIC,
4349 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m",
4351 }
4353
4354 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_CONTROL_FILE_SYNC);
4355 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
4356 ereport(PANIC,
4358 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m",
4361
4362 if (close(fd) != 0)
4363 ereport(PANIC,
4365 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m",
4367}
#define PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE
Definition: pg_control.h:258

References BasicOpenFile(), ControlFileData::blcksz, CATALOG_VERSION_NO, ControlFileData::catalog_version_no, close, COMP_CRC32C, ControlFile, ControlFileData::crc, crc, ControlFileData::default_char_signedness, ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), fd(), FIN_CRC32C, ControlFileData::float8ByVal, ControlFileData::floatFormat, FLOATFORMAT_VALUE, INDEX_MAX_KEYS, ControlFileData::indexMaxKeys, INIT_CRC32C, ControlFileData::loblksize, LOBLKSIZE, ControlFileData::maxAlign, ControlFileData::nameDataLen, NAMEDATALEN, PANIC, PG_BINARY, PG_CONTROL_FILE_SIZE, PG_CONTROL_VERSION, ControlFileData::pg_control_version, pg_fsync(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), ControlFileData::relseg_size, ControlFileData::slru_pages_per_segment, SLRU_PAGES_PER_SEGMENT, TOAST_MAX_CHUNK_SIZE, ControlFileData::toast_max_chunk_size, wal_segment_size, write, ControlFileData::xlog_blcksz, XLOG_CONTROL_FILE, and ControlFileData::xlog_seg_size.

Referenced by BootStrapXLOG().

◆ xlog_redo()

void xlog_redo ( XLogReaderState record)

Definition at line 8303 of file xlog.c.

8304{
8305 uint8 info = XLogRecGetInfo(record) & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
8306 XLogRecPtr lsn = record->EndRecPtr;
8307
8308 /*
8309 * In XLOG rmgr, backup blocks are only used by XLOG_FPI and
8310 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records.
8311 */
8312 Assert(info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT ||
8313 !XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(record));
8314
8315 if (info == XLOG_NEXTOID)
8316 {
8317 Oid nextOid;
8318
8319 /*
8320 * We used to try to take the maximum of TransamVariables->nextOid and
8321 * the recorded nextOid, but that fails if the OID counter wraps
8322 * around. Since no OID allocation should be happening during replay
8323 * anyway, better to just believe the record exactly. We still take
8324 * OidGenLock while setting the variable, just in case.
8325 */
8326 memcpy(&nextOid, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(Oid));
8327 LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8328 TransamVariables->nextOid = nextOid;
8330 LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
8331 }
8332 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN)
8333 {
8334 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8335 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8336
8337 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8338 /* In a SHUTDOWN checkpoint, believe the counters exactly */
8339 LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8340 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8341 LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
8342 LWLockAcquire(OidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8343 TransamVariables->nextOid = checkPoint.nextOid;
8345 LWLockRelease(OidGenLock);
8347 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8348
8350 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8351
8352 /*
8353 * No need to set oldestClogXid here as well; it'll be set when we
8354 * redo an xl_clog_truncate if it changed since initialization.
8355 */
8356 SetTransactionIdLimit(checkPoint.oldestXid, checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8357
8358 /*
8359 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint while waiting for an end-of-backup
8360 * record, the backup was canceled and the end-of-backup record will
8361 * never arrive.
8362 */
8366 ereport(PANIC,
8367 (errmsg("online backup was canceled, recovery cannot continue")));
8368
8369 /*
8370 * If we see a shutdown checkpoint, we know that nothing was running
8371 * on the primary at this point. So fake-up an empty running-xacts
8372 * record and use that here and now. Recover additional standby state
8373 * for prepared transactions.
8374 */
8376 {
8377 TransactionId *xids;
8378 int nxids;
8379 TransactionId oldestActiveXID;
8380 TransactionId latestCompletedXid;
8382
8383 oldestActiveXID = PrescanPreparedTransactions(&xids, &nxids);
8384
8385 /* Update pg_subtrans entries for any prepared transactions */
8387
8388 /*
8389 * Construct a RunningTransactions snapshot representing a shut
8390 * down server, with only prepared transactions still alive. We're
8391 * never overflowed at this point because all subxids are listed
8392 * with their parent prepared transactions.
8393 */
8394 running.xcnt = nxids;
8395 running.subxcnt = 0;
8397 running.nextXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8398 running.oldestRunningXid = oldestActiveXID;
8399 latestCompletedXid = XidFromFullTransactionId(checkPoint.nextXid);
8400 TransactionIdRetreat(latestCompletedXid);
8401 Assert(TransactionIdIsNormal(latestCompletedXid));
8402 running.latestCompletedXid = latestCompletedXid;
8403 running.xids = xids;
8404
8406 }
8407
8408 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8409 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8411 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
8412
8413 /*
8414 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8415 * record.
8416 */
8417 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8418 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8419 ereport(PANIC,
8420 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in shutdown checkpoint record",
8421 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8422
8423 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8424
8425 /*
8426 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8427 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8428 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8429 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8430 */
8432 }
8433 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE)
8434 {
8435 CheckPoint checkPoint;
8436 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8437
8438 memcpy(&checkPoint, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(CheckPoint));
8439 /* In an ONLINE checkpoint, treat the XID counter as a minimum */
8440 LWLockAcquire(XidGenLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8442 checkPoint.nextXid))
8443 TransamVariables->nextXid = checkPoint.nextXid;
8444 LWLockRelease(XidGenLock);
8445
8446 /*
8447 * We ignore the nextOid counter in an ONLINE checkpoint, preferring
8448 * to track OID assignment through XLOG_NEXTOID records. The nextOid
8449 * counter is from the start of the checkpoint and might well be stale
8450 * compared to later XLOG_NEXTOID records. We could try to take the
8451 * maximum of the nextOid counter and our latest value, but since
8452 * there's no particular guarantee about the speed with which the OID
8453 * counter wraps around, that's a risky thing to do. In any case,
8454 * users of the nextOid counter are required to avoid assignment of
8455 * duplicates, so that a somewhat out-of-date value should be safe.
8456 */
8457
8458 /* Handle multixact */
8460 checkPoint.nextMultiOffset);
8461
8462 /*
8463 * NB: This may perform multixact truncation when replaying WAL
8464 * generated by an older primary.
8465 */
8467 checkPoint.oldestMultiDB);
8469 checkPoint.oldestXid))
8471 checkPoint.oldestXidDB);
8472 /* ControlFile->checkPointCopy always tracks the latest ckpt XID */
8473 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8475 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
8476
8477 /* TLI should not change in an on-line checkpoint */
8478 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8479 if (checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8480 ereport(PANIC,
8481 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in online checkpoint record",
8482 checkPoint.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8483
8484 RecoveryRestartPoint(&checkPoint, record);
8485
8486 /*
8487 * After replaying a checkpoint record, free all smgr objects.
8488 * Otherwise we would never do so for dropped relations, as the
8489 * startup does not process shared invalidation messages or call
8490 * AtEOXact_SMgr().
8491 */
8493 }
8494 else if (info == XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD)
8495 {
8496 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8497 }
8498 else if (info == XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY)
8499 {
8500 xl_end_of_recovery xlrec;
8501 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8502
8503 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_end_of_recovery));
8504
8505 /*
8506 * For Hot Standby, we could treat this like a Shutdown Checkpoint,
8507 * but this case is rarer and harder to test, so the benefit doesn't
8508 * outweigh the potential extra cost of maintenance.
8509 */
8510
8511 /*
8512 * We should've already switched to the new TLI before replaying this
8513 * record.
8514 */
8515 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8516 if (xlrec.ThisTimeLineID != replayTLI)
8517 ereport(PANIC,
8518 (errmsg("unexpected timeline ID %u (should be %u) in end-of-recovery record",
8519 xlrec.ThisTimeLineID, replayTLI)));
8520 }
8521 else if (info == XLOG_NOOP)
8522 {
8523 /* nothing to do here */
8524 }
8525 else if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
8526 {
8527 /* nothing to do here */
8528 }
8529 else if (info == XLOG_RESTORE_POINT)
8530 {
8531 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery.c */
8532 }
8533 else if (info == XLOG_FPI || info == XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT)
8534 {
8535 /*
8536 * XLOG_FPI records contain nothing else but one or more block
8537 * references. Every block reference must include a full-page image
8538 * even if full_page_writes was disabled when the record was generated
8539 * - otherwise there would be no point in this record.
8540 *
8541 * XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT records are generated when a page needs to be
8542 * WAL-logged because of a hint bit update. They are only generated
8543 * when checksums and/or wal_log_hints are enabled. They may include
8544 * no full-page images if full_page_writes was disabled when they were
8545 * generated. In this case there is nothing to do here.
8546 *
8547 * No recovery conflicts are generated by these generic records - if a
8548 * resource manager needs to generate conflicts, it has to define a
8549 * separate WAL record type and redo routine.
8550 */
8551 for (uint8 block_id = 0; block_id <= XLogRecMaxBlockId(record); block_id++)
8552 {
8553 Buffer buffer;
8554
8555 if (!XLogRecHasBlockImage(record, block_id))
8556 {
8557 if (info == XLOG_FPI)
8558 elog(ERROR, "XLOG_FPI record did not contain a full-page image");
8559 continue;
8560 }
8561
8562 if (XLogReadBufferForRedo(record, block_id, &buffer) != BLK_RESTORED)
8563 elog(ERROR, "unexpected XLogReadBufferForRedo result when restoring backup block");
8564 UnlockReleaseBuffer(buffer);
8565 }
8566 }
8567 else if (info == XLOG_BACKUP_END)
8568 {
8569 /* nothing to do here, handled in xlogrecovery_redo() */
8570 }
8571 else if (info == XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE)
8572 {
8573 xl_parameter_change xlrec;
8574
8575 /* Update our copy of the parameters in pg_control */
8576 memcpy(&xlrec, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(xl_parameter_change));
8577
8578 /*
8579 * Invalidate logical slots if we are in hot standby and the primary
8580 * does not have a WAL level sufficient for logical decoding. No need
8581 * to search for potentially conflicting logically slots if standby is
8582 * running with wal_level lower than logical, because in that case, we
8583 * would have either disallowed creation of logical slots or
8584 * invalidated existing ones.
8585 */
8586 if (InRecovery && InHotStandby &&
8587 xlrec.wal_level < WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL &&
8590 0, InvalidOid,
8592
8593 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8601
8602 /*
8603 * Update minRecoveryPoint to ensure that if recovery is aborted, we
8604 * recover back up to this point before allowing hot standby again.
8605 * This is important if the max_* settings are decreased, to ensure
8606 * you don't run queries against the WAL preceding the change. The
8607 * local copies cannot be updated as long as crash recovery is
8608 * happening and we expect all the WAL to be replayed.
8609 */
8611 {
8614 }
8616 {
8617 TimeLineID replayTLI;
8618
8619 (void) GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(&replayTLI);
8621 ControlFile->minRecoveryPointTLI = replayTLI;
8622 }
8623
8627
8629 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
8630
8631 /* Check to see if any parameter change gives a problem on recovery */
8633 }
8634 else if (info == XLOG_FPW_CHANGE)
8635 {
8636 bool fpw;
8637
8638 memcpy(&fpw, XLogRecGetData(record), sizeof(bool));
8639
8640 /*
8641 * Update the LSN of the last replayed XLOG_FPW_CHANGE record so that
8642 * do_pg_backup_start() and do_pg_backup_stop() can check whether
8643 * full_page_writes has been disabled during online backup.
8644 */
8645 if (!fpw)
8646 {
8651 }
8652
8653 /* Keep track of full_page_writes */
8654 lastFullPageWrites = fpw;
8655 }
8656 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
8657 {
8658 /* nothing to do here, just for informational purposes */
8659 }
8660}
int Buffer
Definition: buf.h:23
void UnlockReleaseBuffer(Buffer buffer)
Definition: bufmgr.c:5383
uint8_t uint8
Definition: c.h:550
void CommitTsParameterChange(bool newvalue, bool oldvalue)
Definition: commit_ts.c:640
void MultiXactAdvanceOldest(MultiXactId oldestMulti, Oid oldestMultiDB)
Definition: multixact.c:2188
void MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(MultiXactId minMulti, MultiXactOffset minMultiOffset)
Definition: multixact.c:2161
#define XLOG_RESTORE_POINT
Definition: pg_control.h:75
#define XLOG_FPI
Definition: pg_control.h:79
#define XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT
Definition: pg_control.h:78
#define XLOG_NEXTOID
Definition: pg_control.h:71
#define XLOG_NOOP
Definition: pg_control.h:70
#define XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE
Definition: pg_control.h:74
@ RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL
Definition: slot.h:66
void smgrdestroyall(void)
Definition: smgr.c:386
#define FullTransactionIdPrecedes(a, b)
Definition: transam.h:51
static bool TransactionIdPrecedes(TransactionId id1, TransactionId id2)
Definition: transam.h:263
static void RecoveryRestartPoint(const CheckPoint *checkPoint, XLogReaderState *record)
Definition: xlog.c:7617
@ WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL
Definition: xlog.h:76
#define XLogRecGetInfo(decoder)
Definition: xlogreader.h:409
#define XLogRecGetData(decoder)
Definition: xlogreader.h:414
#define XLogRecMaxBlockId(decoder)
Definition: xlogreader.h:417
#define XLogRecHasBlockImage(decoder, block_id)
Definition: xlogreader.h:422
#define XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs(decoder)
Definition: xlogreader.h:416
XLogRedoAction XLogReadBufferForRedo(XLogReaderState *record, uint8 block_id, Buffer *buf)
Definition: xlogutils.c:303
@ STANDBY_INITIALIZED
Definition: xlogutils.h:53
#define InHotStandby
Definition: xlogutils.h:60
@ BLK_RESTORED
Definition: xlogutils.h:76

References ArchiveRecoveryRequested, Assert(), ControlFileData::backupEndPoint, ControlFileData::backupStartPoint, BLK_RESTORED, ControlFileData::checkPointCopy, CheckRequiredParameterValues(), CommitTsParameterChange(), ControlFile, elog, XLogReaderState::EndRecPtr, ereport, errmsg(), ERROR, FullTransactionIdPrecedes, GetCurrentReplayRecPtr(), InArchiveRecovery, XLogCtlData::info_lck, InHotStandby, InRecovery, InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(), InvalidOid, InvalidTransactionId, XLogCtlData::lastFpwDisableRecPtr, lastFullPageWrites, RunningTransactionsData::latestCompletedXid, LocalMinRecoveryPoint, LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), xl_parameter_change::max_locks_per_xact, ControlFileData::max_locks_per_xact, xl_parameter_change::max_prepared_xacts, ControlFileData::max_prepared_xacts, xl_parameter_change::max_wal_senders, ControlFileData::max_wal_senders, xl_parameter_change::max_worker_processes, ControlFileData::max_worker_processes, xl_parameter_change::MaxConnections, ControlFileData::MaxConnections, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, MultiXactAdvanceNextMXact(), MultiXactAdvanceOldest(), MultiXactSetNextMXact(), CheckPoint::nextMulti, CheckPoint::nextMultiOffset, TransamVariablesData::nextOid, CheckPoint::nextOid, TransamVariablesData::nextXid, CheckPoint::nextXid, RunningTransactionsData::nextXid, TransamVariablesData::oidCount, CheckPoint::oldestMulti, CheckPoint::oldestMultiDB, RunningTransactionsData::oldestRunningXid, TransamVariablesData::oldestXid, CheckPoint::oldestXid, CheckPoint::oldestXidDB, PANIC, PrescanPreparedTransactions(), ProcArrayApplyRecoveryInfo(), XLogReaderState::ReadRecPtr, RecoveryRestartPoint(), RS_INVAL_WAL_LEVEL, SetTransactionIdLimit(), smgrdestroyall(), SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, STANDBY_INITIALIZED, StandbyRecoverPreparedTransactions(), standbyState, RunningTransactionsData::subxcnt, RunningTransactionsData::subxid_status, SUBXIDS_IN_SUBTRANS, xl_end_of_recovery::ThisTimeLineID, CheckPoint::ThisTimeLineID, xl_parameter_change::track_commit_timestamp, ControlFileData::track_commit_timestamp, TransactionIdIsNormal, TransactionIdPrecedes(), TransactionIdRetreat, TransamVariables, UnlockReleaseBuffer(), UpdateControlFile(), wal_level, xl_parameter_change::wal_level, ControlFileData::wal_level, WAL_LEVEL_LOGICAL, xl_parameter_change::wal_log_hints, ControlFileData::wal_log_hints, RunningTransactionsData::xcnt, XidFromFullTransactionId, RunningTransactionsData::xids, XLOG_BACKUP_END, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_ONLINE, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_SHUTDOWN, XLOG_END_OF_RECOVERY, XLOG_FPI, XLOG_FPI_FOR_HINT, XLOG_FPW_CHANGE, XLOG_NEXTOID, XLOG_NOOP, XLOG_OVERWRITE_CONTRECORD, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE, XLOG_RESTORE_POINT, XLOG_SWITCH, XLogCtl, XLogReadBufferForRedo(), XLogRecGetData, XLogRecGetInfo, XLogRecHasAnyBlockRefs, XLogRecHasBlockImage, XLogRecMaxBlockId, and XLogRecPtrIsValid.

◆ XLogBackgroundFlush()

bool XLogBackgroundFlush ( void  )

Definition at line 2980 of file xlog.c.

2981{
2982 XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
2983 bool flexible = true;
2984 static TimestampTz lastflush;
2986 int flushblocks;
2987 TimeLineID insertTLI;
2988
2989 /* XLOG doesn't need flushing during recovery */
2990 if (RecoveryInProgress())
2991 return false;
2992
2993 /*
2994 * Since we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't change,
2995 * so we can read it without a lock.
2996 */
2997 insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
2998
2999 /* read updated LogwrtRqst */
3001 WriteRqst = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst;
3003
3004 /* back off to last completed page boundary */
3005 WriteRqst.Write -= WriteRqst.Write % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
3006
3007 /* if we have already flushed that far, consider async commit records */
3009 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3010 {
3012 WriteRqst.Write = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
3014 flexible = false; /* ensure it all gets written */
3015 }
3016
3017 /*
3018 * If already known flushed, we're done. Just need to check if we are
3019 * holding an open file handle to a logfile that's no longer in use,
3020 * preventing the file from being deleted.
3021 */
3022 if (WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3023 {
3024 if (openLogFile >= 0)
3025 {
3028 {
3029 XLogFileClose();
3030 }
3031 }
3032 return false;
3033 }
3034
3035 /*
3036 * Determine how far to flush WAL, based on the wal_writer_delay and
3037 * wal_writer_flush_after GUCs.
3038 *
3039 * Note that XLogSetAsyncXactLSN() performs similar calculation based on
3040 * wal_writer_flush_after, to decide when to wake us up. Make sure the
3041 * logic is the same in both places if you change this.
3042 */
3044 flushblocks =
3045 WriteRqst.Write / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
3046
3047 if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || lastflush == 0)
3048 {
3049 /* first call, or block based limits disabled */
3050 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3051 lastflush = now;
3052 }
3053 else if (TimestampDifferenceExceeds(lastflush, now, WalWriterDelay))
3054 {
3055 /*
3056 * Flush the writes at least every WalWriterDelay ms. This is
3057 * important to bound the amount of time it takes for an asynchronous
3058 * commit to hit disk.
3059 */
3060 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3061 lastflush = now;
3062 }
3063 else if (flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
3064 {
3065 /* exceeded wal_writer_flush_after blocks, flush */
3066 WriteRqst.Flush = WriteRqst.Write;
3067 lastflush = now;
3068 }
3069 else
3070 {
3071 /* no flushing, this time round */
3072 WriteRqst.Flush = 0;
3073 }
3074
3075#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
3076 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
3077 elog(LOG, "xlog bg flush request write %X/%08X; flush: %X/%08X, current is write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
3078 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Write),
3079 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(WriteRqst.Flush),
3082#endif
3083
3085
3086 /* now wait for any in-progress insertions to finish and get write lock */
3088 LWLockAcquire(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
3090 if (WriteRqst.Write > LogwrtResult.Write ||
3091 WriteRqst.Flush > LogwrtResult.Flush)
3092 {
3093 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, flexible);
3094 }
3095 LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
3096
3098
3099 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
3101
3102 /*
3103 * Great, done. To take some work off the critical path, try to initialize
3104 * as many of the no-longer-needed WAL buffers for future use as we can.
3105 */
3106 AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(InvalidXLogRecPtr, insertTLI, true);
3107
3108 /*
3109 * If we determined that we need to write data, but somebody else
3110 * wrote/flushed already, it should be considered as being active, to
3111 * avoid hibernating too early.
3112 */
3113 return true;
3114}
bool TimestampDifferenceExceeds(TimestampTz start_time, TimestampTz stop_time, int msec)
Definition: timestamp.c:1781
Datum now(PG_FUNCTION_ARGS)
Definition: timestamp.c:1609
XLogRecPtr asyncXactLSN
Definition: xlog.c:459
static void WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(bool physical, bool logical)
Definition: walsender.h:65
int WalWriterFlushAfter
Definition: walwriter.c:71
int WalWriterDelay
Definition: walwriter.c:70
#define XLByteInPrevSeg(xlrp, logSegNo, wal_segsz_bytes)

References AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), XLogCtlData::asyncXactLSN, elog, END_CRIT_SECTION, XLogwrtRqst::Flush, XLogwrtResult::Flush, GetCurrentTimestamp(), XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, InvalidXLogRecPtr, LOG, LogwrtResult, XLogCtlData::LogwrtRqst, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), now(), openLogFile, openLogSegNo, RecoveryInProgress(), RefreshXLogWriteResult, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, START_CRIT_SECTION, TimestampDifferenceExceeds(), WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(), wal_segment_size, WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(), WalWriterDelay, WalWriterFlushAfter, XLogwrtRqst::Write, XLogwrtResult::Write, XLByteInPrevSeg, XLogCtl, XLogFileClose(), and XLogWrite().

Referenced by WalSndWaitForWal(), and WalWriterMain().

◆ XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr()

static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr ( uint64  bytepos)
static

Definition at line 1904 of file xlog.c.

1905{
1906 uint64 fullsegs;
1907 uint64 fullpages;
1908 uint64 bytesleft;
1909 uint32 seg_offset;
1910 XLogRecPtr result;
1911
1912 fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
1913 bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
1914
1915 if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
1916 {
1917 /* fits on first page of segment */
1918 if (bytesleft == 0)
1919 seg_offset = 0;
1920 else
1921 seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1922 }
1923 else
1924 {
1925 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1926 seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1927 bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1928
1929 fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
1930 bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
1931
1932 if (bytesleft == 0)
1933 seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft;
1934 else
1935 seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1936 }
1937
1938 XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
1939
1940 return result;
1941}
#define XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(segno, offset, wal_segsz_bytes, dest)

References SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, UsableBytesInPage, UsableBytesInSegment, wal_segment_size, and XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr.

Referenced by ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), ReserveXLogSwitch(), and WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish().

◆ XLogBytePosToRecPtr()

static XLogRecPtr XLogBytePosToRecPtr ( uint64  bytepos)
static

Definition at line 1864 of file xlog.c.

1865{
1866 uint64 fullsegs;
1867 uint64 fullpages;
1868 uint64 bytesleft;
1869 uint32 seg_offset;
1870 XLogRecPtr result;
1871
1872 fullsegs = bytepos / UsableBytesInSegment;
1873 bytesleft = bytepos % UsableBytesInSegment;
1874
1875 if (bytesleft < XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD)
1876 {
1877 /* fits on first page of segment */
1878 seg_offset = bytesleft + SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1879 }
1880 else
1881 {
1882 /* account for the first page on segment with long header */
1883 seg_offset = XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1884 bytesleft -= XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1885
1886 fullpages = bytesleft / UsableBytesInPage;
1887 bytesleft = bytesleft % UsableBytesInPage;
1888
1889 seg_offset += fullpages * XLOG_BLCKSZ + bytesleft + SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1890 }
1891
1892 XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr(fullsegs, seg_offset, wal_segment_size, result);
1893
1894 return result;
1895}

References SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, UsableBytesInPage, UsableBytesInSegment, wal_segment_size, and XLogSegNoOffsetToRecPtr.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), GetXLogInsertRecPtr(), ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), and ReserveXLogSwitch().

◆ XLogCheckpointNeeded()

bool XLogCheckpointNeeded ( XLogSegNo  new_segno)

Definition at line 2283 of file xlog.c.

2284{
2285 XLogSegNo old_segno;
2286
2288
2289 if (new_segno >= old_segno + (uint64) (CheckPointSegments - 1))
2290 return true;
2291 return false;
2292}

References CheckPointSegments, RedoRecPtr, wal_segment_size, and XLByteToSeg.

Referenced by XLogPageRead(), and XLogWrite().

◆ XLOGChooseNumBuffers()

static int XLOGChooseNumBuffers ( void  )
static

Definition at line 4677 of file xlog.c.

4678{
4679 int xbuffers;
4680
4681 xbuffers = NBuffers / 32;
4682 if (xbuffers > (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ))
4683 xbuffers = (wal_segment_size / XLOG_BLCKSZ);
4684 if (xbuffers < 8)
4685 xbuffers = 8;
4686 return xbuffers;
4687}

References NBuffers, and wal_segment_size.

Referenced by check_wal_buffers(), and XLOGShmemSize().

◆ XLogFileClose()

static void XLogFileClose ( void  )
static

Definition at line 3660 of file xlog.c.

3661{
3662 Assert(openLogFile >= 0);
3663
3664 /*
3665 * WAL segment files will not be re-read in normal operation, so we advise
3666 * the OS to release any cached pages. But do not do so if WAL archiving
3667 * or streaming is active, because archiver and walsender process could
3668 * use the cache to read the WAL segment.
3669 */
3670#if defined(USE_POSIX_FADVISE) && defined(POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED)
3671 if (!XLogIsNeeded() && (io_direct_flags & IO_DIRECT_WAL) == 0)
3672 (void) posix_fadvise(openLogFile, 0, 0, POSIX_FADV_DONTNEED);
3673#endif
3674
3675 if (close(openLogFile) != 0)
3676 {
3677 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
3678 int save_errno = errno;
3679
3681 errno = save_errno;
3682 ereport(PANIC,
3684 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
3685 }
3686
3687 openLogFile = -1;
3689}
void ReleaseExternalFD(void)
Definition: fd.c:1221

References Assert(), close, ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), io_direct_flags, IO_DIRECT_WAL, MAXFNAMELEN, openLogFile, openLogSegNo, openLogTLI, PANIC, ReleaseExternalFD(), wal_segment_size, XLogFileName(), and XLogIsNeeded.

Referenced by assign_wal_sync_method(), XLogBackgroundFlush(), and XLogWrite().

◆ XLogFileCopy()

static void XLogFileCopy ( TimeLineID  destTLI,
XLogSegNo  destsegno,
TimeLineID  srcTLI,
XLogSegNo  srcsegno,
int  upto 
)
static

Definition at line 3439 of file xlog.c.

3442{
3443 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3444 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3445 PGAlignedXLogBlock buffer;
3446 int srcfd;
3447 int fd;
3448 int nbytes;
3449
3450 /*
3451 * Open the source file
3452 */
3453 XLogFilePath(path, srcTLI, srcsegno, wal_segment_size);
3454 srcfd = OpenTransientFile(path, O_RDONLY | PG_BINARY);
3455 if (srcfd < 0)
3456 ereport(ERROR,
3458 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3459
3460 /*
3461 * Copy into a temp file name.
3462 */
3463 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3464
3465 unlink(tmppath);
3466
3467 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3468 fd = OpenTransientFile(tmppath, O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY);
3469 if (fd < 0)
3470 ereport(ERROR,
3472 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3473
3474 /*
3475 * Do the data copying.
3476 */
3477 for (nbytes = 0; nbytes < wal_segment_size; nbytes += sizeof(buffer))
3478 {
3479 int nread;
3480
3481 nread = upto - nbytes;
3482
3483 /*
3484 * The part that is not read from the source file is filled with
3485 * zeros.
3486 */
3487 if (nread < sizeof(buffer))
3488 memset(buffer.data, 0, sizeof(buffer));
3489
3490 if (nread > 0)
3491 {
3492 int r;
3493
3494 if (nread > sizeof(buffer))
3495 nread = sizeof(buffer);
3496 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_READ);
3497 r = read(srcfd, buffer.data, nread);
3498 if (r != nread)
3499 {
3500 if (r < 0)
3501 ereport(ERROR,
3503 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": %m",
3504 path)));
3505 else
3506 ereport(ERROR,
3508 errmsg("could not read file \"%s\": read %d of %zu",
3509 path, r, (Size) nread)));
3510 }
3512 }
3513 errno = 0;
3514 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_WRITE);
3515 if ((int) write(fd, buffer.data, sizeof(buffer)) != (int) sizeof(buffer))
3516 {
3517 int save_errno = errno;
3518
3519 /*
3520 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3521 */
3522 unlink(tmppath);
3523 /* if write didn't set errno, assume problem is no disk space */
3524 errno = save_errno ? save_errno : ENOSPC;
3525
3526 ereport(ERROR,
3528 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3529 }
3531 }
3532
3533 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_COPY_SYNC);
3534 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3537 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3539
3540 if (CloseTransientFile(fd) != 0)
3541 ereport(ERROR,
3543 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3544
3545 if (CloseTransientFile(srcfd) != 0)
3546 ereport(ERROR,
3548 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3549
3550 /*
3551 * Now move the segment into place with its final name.
3552 */
3553 if (!InstallXLogFileSegment(&destsegno, tmppath, false, 0, destTLI))
3554 elog(ERROR, "InstallXLogFileSegment should not have failed");
3555}
int CloseTransientFile(int fd)
Definition: fd.c:2851
int data_sync_elevel(int elevel)
Definition: fd.c:3982
int OpenTransientFile(const char *fileName, int fileFlags)
Definition: fd.c:2674
char data[XLOG_BLCKSZ]
Definition: c.h:1148

References CloseTransientFile(), PGAlignedXLogBlock::data, data_sync_elevel(), elog, ereport, errcode(), ERRCODE_DATA_CORRUPTED, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), ERROR, fd(), InstallXLogFileSegment(), MAXPGPATH, OpenTransientFile(), PG_BINARY, pg_fsync(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), read, snprintf, wal_segment_size, write, XLOGDIR, and XLogFilePath().

Referenced by XLogInitNewTimeline().

◆ XLogFileInit()

int XLogFileInit ( XLogSegNo  logsegno,
TimeLineID  logtli 
)

Definition at line 3401 of file xlog.c.

3402{
3403 bool ignore_added;
3404 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3405 int fd;
3406
3407 Assert(logtli != 0);
3408
3409 fd = XLogFileInitInternal(logsegno, logtli, &ignore_added, path);
3410 if (fd >= 0)
3411 return fd;
3412
3413 /* Now open original target segment (might not be file I just made) */
3414 fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
3416 if (fd < 0)
3417 ereport(ERROR,
3419 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3420 return fd;
3421}
#define O_CLOEXEC
Definition: win32_port.h:344

References Assert(), BasicOpenFile(), ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), ERROR, fd(), get_sync_bit(), MAXPGPATH, O_CLOEXEC, PG_BINARY, wal_sync_method, and XLogFileInitInternal().

Referenced by BootStrapXLOG(), XLogInitNewTimeline(), XLogWalRcvWrite(), and XLogWrite().

◆ XLogFileInitInternal()

static int XLogFileInitInternal ( XLogSegNo  logsegno,
TimeLineID  logtli,
bool *  added,
char *  path 
)
static

Definition at line 3213 of file xlog.c.

3215{
3216 char tmppath[MAXPGPATH];
3217 XLogSegNo installed_segno;
3218 XLogSegNo max_segno;
3219 int fd;
3220 int save_errno;
3221 int open_flags = O_RDWR | O_CREAT | O_EXCL | PG_BINARY;
3222 instr_time io_start;
3223
3224 Assert(logtli != 0);
3225
3226 XLogFilePath(path, logtli, logsegno, wal_segment_size);
3227
3228 /*
3229 * Try to use existent file (checkpoint maker may have created it already)
3230 */
3231 *added = false;
3232 fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
3234 if (fd < 0)
3235 {
3236 if (errno != ENOENT)
3237 ereport(ERROR,
3239 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3240 }
3241 else
3242 return fd;
3243
3244 /*
3245 * Initialize an empty (all zeroes) segment. NOTE: it is possible that
3246 * another process is doing the same thing. If so, we will end up
3247 * pre-creating an extra log segment. That seems OK, and better than
3248 * holding the lock throughout this lengthy process.
3249 */
3250 elog(DEBUG2, "creating and filling new WAL file");
3251
3252 snprintf(tmppath, MAXPGPATH, XLOGDIR "/xlogtemp.%d", (int) getpid());
3253
3254 unlink(tmppath);
3255
3257 open_flags |= PG_O_DIRECT;
3258
3259 /* do not use get_sync_bit() here --- want to fsync only at end of fill */
3260 fd = BasicOpenFile(tmppath, open_flags);
3261 if (fd < 0)
3262 ereport(ERROR,
3264 errmsg("could not create file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3265
3266 /* Measure I/O timing when initializing segment */
3268
3269 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_WRITE);
3270 save_errno = 0;
3271 if (wal_init_zero)
3272 {
3273 ssize_t rc;
3274
3275 /*
3276 * Zero-fill the file. With this setting, we do this the hard way to
3277 * ensure that all the file space has really been allocated. On
3278 * platforms that allow "holes" in files, just seeking to the end
3279 * doesn't allocate intermediate space. This way, we know that we
3280 * have all the space and (after the fsync below) that all the
3281 * indirect blocks are down on disk. Therefore, fdatasync(2) or
3282 * O_DSYNC will be sufficient to sync future writes to the log file.
3283 */
3285
3286 if (rc < 0)
3287 save_errno = errno;
3288 }
3289 else
3290 {
3291 /*
3292 * Otherwise, seeking to the end and writing a solitary byte is
3293 * enough.
3294 */
3295 errno = 0;
3296 if (pg_pwrite(fd, "\0", 1, wal_segment_size - 1) != 1)
3297 {
3298 /* if write didn't set errno, assume no disk space */
3299 save_errno = errno ? errno : ENOSPC;
3300 }
3301 }
3303
3304 /*
3305 * A full segment worth of data is written when using wal_init_zero. One
3306 * byte is written when not using it.
3307 */
3309 io_start, 1,
3311
3312 if (save_errno)
3313 {
3314 /*
3315 * If we fail to make the file, delete it to release disk space
3316 */
3317 unlink(tmppath);
3318
3319 close(fd);
3320
3321 errno = save_errno;
3322
3323 ereport(ERROR,
3325 errmsg("could not write to file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3326 }
3327
3328 /* Measure I/O timing when flushing segment */
3330
3331 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_INIT_SYNC);
3332 if (pg_fsync(fd) != 0)
3333 {
3334 save_errno = errno;
3335 close(fd);
3336 errno = save_errno;
3337 ereport(ERROR,
3339 errmsg("could not fsync file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3340 }
3342
3344 IOOP_FSYNC, io_start, 1, 0);
3345
3346 if (close(fd) != 0)
3347 ereport(ERROR,
3349 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", tmppath)));
3350
3351 /*
3352 * Now move the segment into place with its final name. Cope with
3353 * possibility that someone else has created the file while we were
3354 * filling ours: if so, use ours to pre-create a future log segment.
3355 */
3356 installed_segno = logsegno;
3357
3358 /*
3359 * XXX: What should we use as max_segno? We used to use XLOGfileslop when
3360 * that was a constant, but that was always a bit dubious: normally, at a
3361 * checkpoint, XLOGfileslop was the offset from the checkpoint record, but
3362 * here, it was the offset from the insert location. We can't do the
3363 * normal XLOGfileslop calculation here because we don't have access to
3364 * the prior checkpoint's redo location. So somewhat arbitrarily, just use
3365 * CheckPointSegments.
3366 */
3367 max_segno = logsegno + CheckPointSegments;
3368 if (InstallXLogFileSegment(&installed_segno, tmppath, true, max_segno,
3369 logtli))
3370 {
3371 *added = true;
3372 elog(DEBUG2, "done creating and filling new WAL file");
3373 }
3374 else
3375 {
3376 /*
3377 * No need for any more future segments, or InstallXLogFileSegment()
3378 * failed to rename the file into place. If the rename failed, a
3379 * caller opening the file may fail.
3380 */
3381 unlink(tmppath);
3382 elog(DEBUG2, "abandoned new WAL file");
3383 }
3384
3385 return -1;
3386}
#define IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT
Definition: fd.h:56
ssize_t pg_pwrite_zeros(int fd, size_t size, pgoff_t offset)
Definition: file_utils.c:709
@ IOCONTEXT_INIT
Definition: pgstat.h:288
@ IOOP_WRITE
Definition: pgstat.h:316
#define pg_pwrite
Definition: port.h:248
bool wal_init_zero
Definition: xlog.c:129

References Assert(), BasicOpenFile(), CheckPointSegments, close, DEBUG2, elog, ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), ERROR, fd(), get_sync_bit(), InstallXLogFileSegment(), io_direct_flags, IO_DIRECT_WAL_INIT, IOCONTEXT_INIT, IOOBJECT_WAL, IOOP_FSYNC, IOOP_WRITE, MAXPGPATH, O_CLOEXEC, PG_BINARY, pg_fsync(), PG_O_DIRECT, pg_pwrite, pg_pwrite_zeros(), pgstat_count_io_op_time(), pgstat_prepare_io_time(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), snprintf, track_wal_io_timing, wal_init_zero, wal_segment_size, wal_sync_method, XLOGDIR, and XLogFilePath().

Referenced by PreallocXlogFiles(), and XLogFileInit().

◆ XLogFileOpen()

int XLogFileOpen ( XLogSegNo  segno,
TimeLineID  tli 
)

Definition at line 3639 of file xlog.c.

3640{
3641 char path[MAXPGPATH];
3642 int fd;
3643
3644 XLogFilePath(path, tli, segno, wal_segment_size);
3645
3646 fd = BasicOpenFile(path, O_RDWR | PG_BINARY | O_CLOEXEC |
3648 if (fd < 0)
3649 ereport(PANIC,
3651 errmsg("could not open file \"%s\": %m", path)));
3652
3653 return fd;
3654}

References BasicOpenFile(), ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), fd(), get_sync_bit(), MAXPGPATH, O_CLOEXEC, PANIC, PG_BINARY, wal_segment_size, wal_sync_method, and XLogFilePath().

Referenced by XLogWrite().

◆ XLOGfileslop()

static XLogSegNo XLOGfileslop ( XLogRecPtr  lastredoptr)
static

Definition at line 2233 of file xlog.c.

2234{
2235 XLogSegNo minSegNo;
2236 XLogSegNo maxSegNo;
2237 double distance;
2238 XLogSegNo recycleSegNo;
2239
2240 /*
2241 * Calculate the segment numbers that min_wal_size_mb and max_wal_size_mb
2242 * correspond to. Always recycle enough segments to meet the minimum, and
2243 * remove enough segments to stay below the maximum.
2244 */
2245 minSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
2247 maxSegNo = lastredoptr / wal_segment_size +
2249
2250 /*
2251 * Between those limits, recycle enough segments to get us through to the
2252 * estimated end of next checkpoint.
2253 *
2254 * To estimate where the next checkpoint will finish, assume that the
2255 * system runs steadily consuming CheckPointDistanceEstimate bytes between
2256 * every checkpoint.
2257 */
2259 /* add 10% for good measure. */
2260 distance *= 1.10;
2261
2262 recycleSegNo = (XLogSegNo) ceil(((double) lastredoptr + distance) /
2264
2265 if (recycleSegNo < minSegNo)
2266 recycleSegNo = minSegNo;
2267 if (recycleSegNo > maxSegNo)
2268 recycleSegNo = maxSegNo;
2269
2270 return recycleSegNo;
2271}

References CheckPointCompletionTarget, CheckPointDistanceEstimate, ConvertToXSegs, max_wal_size_mb, min_wal_size_mb, and wal_segment_size.

Referenced by RemoveOldXlogFiles().

◆ XLogFlush()

void XLogFlush ( XLogRecPtr  record)

Definition at line 2783 of file xlog.c.

2784{
2785 XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr;
2786 XLogwrtRqst WriteRqst;
2787 TimeLineID insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
2788
2789 /*
2790 * During REDO, we are reading not writing WAL. Therefore, instead of
2791 * trying to flush the WAL, we should update minRecoveryPoint instead. We
2792 * test XLogInsertAllowed(), not InRecovery, because we need checkpointer
2793 * to act this way too, and because when it tries to write the
2794 * end-of-recovery checkpoint, it should indeed flush.
2795 */
2796 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
2797 {
2798 UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(record, false);
2799 return;
2800 }
2801
2802 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
2803 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2804 return;
2805
2806#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
2807 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
2808 elog(LOG, "xlog flush request %X/%08X; write %X/%08X; flush %X/%08X",
2809 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2812#endif
2813
2815
2816 /*
2817 * Since fsync is usually a horribly expensive operation, we try to
2818 * piggyback as much data as we can on each fsync: if we see any more data
2819 * entered into the xlog buffer, we'll write and fsync that too, so that
2820 * the final value of LogwrtResult.Flush is as large as possible. This
2821 * gives us some chance of avoiding another fsync immediately after.
2822 */
2823
2824 /* initialize to given target; may increase below */
2825 WriteRqstPtr = record;
2826
2827 /*
2828 * Now wait until we get the write lock, or someone else does the flush
2829 * for us.
2830 */
2831 for (;;)
2832 {
2833 XLogRecPtr insertpos;
2834
2835 /* done already? */
2837 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2838 break;
2839
2840 /*
2841 * Before actually performing the write, wait for all in-flight
2842 * insertions to the pages we're about to write to finish.
2843 */
2845 if (WriteRqstPtr < XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write)
2846 WriteRqstPtr = XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write;
2848 insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(WriteRqstPtr);
2849
2850 /*
2851 * Try to get the write lock. If we can't get it immediately, wait
2852 * until it's released, and recheck if we still need to do the flush
2853 * or if the backend that held the lock did it for us already. This
2854 * helps to maintain a good rate of group committing when the system
2855 * is bottlenecked by the speed of fsyncing.
2856 */
2857 if (!LWLockAcquireOrWait(WALWriteLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE))
2858 {
2859 /*
2860 * The lock is now free, but we didn't acquire it yet. Before we
2861 * do, loop back to check if someone else flushed the record for
2862 * us already.
2863 */
2864 continue;
2865 }
2866
2867 /* Got the lock; recheck whether request is satisfied */
2869 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
2870 {
2871 LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
2872 break;
2873 }
2874
2875 /*
2876 * Sleep before flush! By adding a delay here, we may give further
2877 * backends the opportunity to join the backlog of group commit
2878 * followers; this can significantly improve transaction throughput,
2879 * at the risk of increasing transaction latency.
2880 *
2881 * We do not sleep if enableFsync is not turned on, nor if there are
2882 * fewer than CommitSiblings other backends with active transactions.
2883 */
2884 if (CommitDelay > 0 && enableFsync &&
2886 {
2887 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_COMMIT_DELAY);
2890
2891 /*
2892 * Re-check how far we can now flush the WAL. It's generally not
2893 * safe to call WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish while holding
2894 * WALWriteLock, because an in-progress insertion might need to
2895 * also grab WALWriteLock to make progress. But we know that all
2896 * the insertions up to insertpos have already finished, because
2897 * that's what the earlier WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish() returned.
2898 * We're only calling it again to allow insertpos to be moved
2899 * further forward, not to actually wait for anyone.
2900 */
2901 insertpos = WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(insertpos);
2902 }
2903
2904 /* try to write/flush later additions to XLOG as well */
2905 WriteRqst.Write = insertpos;
2906 WriteRqst.Flush = insertpos;
2907
2908 XLogWrite(WriteRqst, insertTLI, false);
2909
2910 LWLockRelease(WALWriteLock);
2911 /* done */
2912 break;
2913 }
2914
2916
2917 /* wake up walsenders now that we've released heavily contended locks */
2919
2920 /*
2921 * If we still haven't flushed to the request point then we have a
2922 * problem; most likely, the requested flush point is past end of XLOG.
2923 * This has been seen to occur when a disk page has a corrupted LSN.
2924 *
2925 * Formerly we treated this as a PANIC condition, but that hurts the
2926 * system's robustness rather than helping it: we do not want to take down
2927 * the whole system due to corruption on one data page. In particular, if
2928 * the bad page is encountered again during recovery then we would be
2929 * unable to restart the database at all! (This scenario actually
2930 * happened in the field several times with 7.1 releases.) As of 8.4, bad
2931 * LSNs encountered during recovery are UpdateMinRecoveryPoint's problem;
2932 * the only time we can reach here during recovery is while flushing the
2933 * end-of-recovery checkpoint record, and we don't expect that to have a
2934 * bad LSN.
2935 *
2936 * Note that for calls from xact.c, the ERROR will be promoted to PANIC
2937 * since xact.c calls this routine inside a critical section. However,
2938 * calls from bufmgr.c are not within critical sections and so we will not
2939 * force a restart for a bad LSN on a data page.
2940 */
2941 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < record)
2942 elog(ERROR,
2943 "xlog flush request %X/%08X is not satisfied --- flushed only to %X/%08X",
2944 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(record),
2946
2947 /*
2948 * Cross-check XLogNeedsFlush(). Some of the checks of XLogFlush() and
2949 * XLogNeedsFlush() are duplicated, and this assertion ensures that these
2950 * remain consistent.
2951 */
2952 Assert(!XLogNeedsFlush(record));
2953}
bool LWLockAcquireOrWait(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition: lwlock.c:1402
bool MinimumActiveBackends(int min)
Definition: procarray.c:3506
int CommitDelay
Definition: xlog.c:134
int CommitSiblings
Definition: xlog.c:135
bool XLogNeedsFlush(XLogRecPtr record)
Definition: xlog.c:3129
bool XLogInsertAllowed(void)
Definition: xlog.c:6459

References Assert(), CommitDelay, CommitSiblings, elog, enableFsync, END_CRIT_SECTION, ERROR, XLogwrtRqst::Flush, XLogwrtResult::Flush, XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, LOG, LogwrtResult, XLogCtlData::LogwrtRqst, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquireOrWait(), LWLockRelease(), MinimumActiveBackends(), pg_usleep(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), RecoveryInProgress(), RefreshXLogWriteResult, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, START_CRIT_SECTION, UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(), WaitXLogInsertionsToFinish(), WalSndWakeupProcessRequests(), XLogwrtRqst::Write, XLogwrtResult::Write, XLogCtl, XLogInsertAllowed(), XLogNeedsFlush(), and XLogWrite().

Referenced by CheckPointReplicationOrigin(), CreateCheckPoint(), CreateEndOfRecoveryRecord(), CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(), dropdb(), EndPrepare(), FinishSyncWorker(), FlushBuffer(), LogLogicalMessage(), pg_truncate_visibility_map(), RecordTransactionAbortPrepared(), RecordTransactionCommit(), RecordTransactionCommitPrepared(), RelationTruncate(), ReplicationSlotReserveWal(), replorigin_get_progress(), replorigin_session_get_progress(), SlruPhysicalWritePage(), smgr_redo(), write_relmap_file(), WriteMTruncateXlogRec(), WriteTruncateXlogRec(), xact_redo_abort(), xact_redo_commit(), XLogInsertRecord(), and XLogReportParameters().

◆ XLogGetLastRemovedSegno()

XLogSegNo XLogGetLastRemovedSegno ( void  )

Definition at line 3779 of file xlog.c.

3780{
3781 XLogSegNo lastRemovedSegNo;
3782
3784 lastRemovedSegNo = XLogCtl->lastRemovedSegNo;
3786
3787 return lastRemovedSegNo;
3788}

References XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::lastRemovedSegNo, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by copy_replication_slot(), GetWALAvailability(), ReplicationSlotReserveWal(), and reserve_wal_for_local_slot().

◆ XLogGetOldestSegno()

XLogSegNo XLogGetOldestSegno ( TimeLineID  tli)

Definition at line 3795 of file xlog.c.

3796{
3797 DIR *xldir;
3798 struct dirent *xlde;
3799 XLogSegNo oldest_segno = 0;
3800
3801 xldir = AllocateDir(XLOGDIR);
3802 while ((xlde = ReadDir(xldir, XLOGDIR)) != NULL)
3803 {
3804 TimeLineID file_tli;
3805 XLogSegNo file_segno;
3806
3807 /* Ignore files that are not XLOG segments. */
3808 if (!IsXLogFileName(xlde->d_name))
3809 continue;
3810
3811 /* Parse filename to get TLI and segno. */
3812 XLogFromFileName(xlde->d_name, &file_tli, &file_segno,
3814
3815 /* Ignore anything that's not from the TLI of interest. */
3816 if (tli != file_tli)
3817 continue;
3818
3819 /* If it's the oldest so far, update oldest_segno. */
3820 if (oldest_segno == 0 || file_segno < oldest_segno)
3821 oldest_segno = file_segno;
3822 }
3823
3824 FreeDir(xldir);
3825 return oldest_segno;
3826}

References AllocateDir(), dirent::d_name, FreeDir(), IsXLogFileName(), ReadDir(), wal_segment_size, XLOGDIR, and XLogFromFileName().

Referenced by GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(), MaybeRemoveOldWalSummaries(), and reserve_wal_for_local_slot().

◆ XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN()

static XLogRecPtr XLogGetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN ( void  )
static

Definition at line 2682 of file xlog.c.

2683{
2684 XLogRecPtr retval;
2685
2689
2690 return retval;
2691}
XLogRecPtr replicationSlotMinLSN
Definition: xlog.c:460

References XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::replicationSlotMinLSN, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by KeepLogSeg().

◆ XLogInitNewTimeline()

static void XLogInitNewTimeline ( TimeLineID  endTLI,
XLogRecPtr  endOfLog,
TimeLineID  newTLI 
)
static

Definition at line 5266 of file xlog.c.

5267{
5268 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
5269 XLogSegNo endLogSegNo;
5270 XLogSegNo startLogSegNo;
5271
5272 /* we always switch to a new timeline after archive recovery */
5273 Assert(endTLI != newTLI);
5274
5275 /*
5276 * Update min recovery point one last time.
5277 */
5279
5280 /*
5281 * Calculate the last segment on the old timeline, and the first segment
5282 * on the new timeline. If the switch happens in the middle of a segment,
5283 * they are the same, but if the switch happens exactly at a segment
5284 * boundary, startLogSegNo will be endLogSegNo + 1.
5285 */
5286 XLByteToPrevSeg(endOfLog, endLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
5287 XLByteToSeg(endOfLog, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
5288
5289 /*
5290 * Initialize the starting WAL segment for the new timeline. If the switch
5291 * happens in the middle of a segment, copy data from the last WAL segment
5292 * of the old timeline up to the switch point, to the starting WAL segment
5293 * on the new timeline.
5294 */
5295 if (endLogSegNo == startLogSegNo)
5296 {
5297 /*
5298 * Make a copy of the file on the new timeline.
5299 *
5300 * Writing WAL isn't allowed yet, so there are no locking
5301 * considerations. But we should be just as tense as XLogFileInit to
5302 * avoid emplacing a bogus file.
5303 */
5304 XLogFileCopy(newTLI, endLogSegNo, endTLI, endLogSegNo,
5306 }
5307 else
5308 {
5309 /*
5310 * The switch happened at a segment boundary, so just create the next
5311 * segment on the new timeline.
5312 */
5313 int fd;
5314
5315 fd = XLogFileInit(startLogSegNo, newTLI);
5316
5317 if (close(fd) != 0)
5318 {
5319 int save_errno = errno;
5320
5321 XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
5322 errno = save_errno;
5323 ereport(ERROR,
5325 errmsg("could not close file \"%s\": %m", xlogfname)));
5326 }
5327 }
5328
5329 /*
5330 * Let's just make real sure there are not .ready or .done flags posted
5331 * for the new segment.
5332 */
5333 XLogFileName(xlogfname, newTLI, startLogSegNo, wal_segment_size);
5334 XLogArchiveCleanup(xlogfname);
5335}
static void XLogFileCopy(TimeLineID destTLI, XLogSegNo destsegno, TimeLineID srcTLI, XLogSegNo srcsegno, int upto)
Definition: xlog.c:3439

References Assert(), close, ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), ERROR, fd(), InvalidXLogRecPtr, MAXFNAMELEN, UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(), wal_segment_size, XLByteToPrevSeg, XLByteToSeg, XLogArchiveCleanup(), XLogFileCopy(), XLogFileInit(), XLogFileName(), and XLogSegmentOffset.

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ XLogInsertAllowed()

bool XLogInsertAllowed ( void  )

Definition at line 6459 of file xlog.c.

6460{
6461 /*
6462 * If value is "unconditionally true" or "unconditionally false", just
6463 * return it. This provides the normal fast path once recovery is known
6464 * done.
6465 */
6466 if (LocalXLogInsertAllowed >= 0)
6467 return (bool) LocalXLogInsertAllowed;
6468
6469 /*
6470 * Else, must check to see if we're still in recovery.
6471 */
6472 if (RecoveryInProgress())
6473 return false;
6474
6475 /*
6476 * On exit from recovery, reset to "unconditionally true", since there is
6477 * no need to keep checking.
6478 */
6480 return true;
6481}

References LocalXLogInsertAllowed, and RecoveryInProgress().

Referenced by XLogBeginInsert(), XLogFlush(), XLogInsertRecord(), and XLogNeedsFlush().

◆ XLogInsertRecord()

XLogRecPtr XLogInsertRecord ( XLogRecData rdata,
XLogRecPtr  fpw_lsn,
uint8  flags,
int  num_fpi,
uint64  fpi_bytes,
bool  topxid_included 
)

Definition at line 749 of file xlog.c.

755{
757 pg_crc32c rdata_crc;
758 bool inserted;
759 XLogRecord *rechdr = (XLogRecord *) rdata->data;
760 uint8 info = rechdr->xl_info & ~XLR_INFO_MASK;
762 XLogRecPtr StartPos;
763 XLogRecPtr EndPos;
764 bool prevDoPageWrites = doPageWrites;
765 TimeLineID insertTLI;
766
767 /* Does this record type require special handling? */
768 if (unlikely(rechdr->xl_rmid == RM_XLOG_ID))
769 {
770 if (info == XLOG_SWITCH)
772 else if (info == XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO)
774 }
775
776 /* we assume that all of the record header is in the first chunk */
777 Assert(rdata->len >= SizeOfXLogRecord);
778
779 /* cross-check on whether we should be here or not */
780 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
781 elog(ERROR, "cannot make new WAL entries during recovery");
782
783 /*
784 * Given that we're not in recovery, InsertTimeLineID is set and can't
785 * change, so we can read it without a lock.
786 */
787 insertTLI = XLogCtl->InsertTimeLineID;
788
789 /*----------
790 *
791 * We have now done all the preparatory work we can without holding a
792 * lock or modifying shared state. From here on, inserting the new WAL
793 * record to the shared WAL buffer cache is a two-step process:
794 *
795 * 1. Reserve the right amount of space from the WAL. The current head of
796 * reserved space is kept in Insert->CurrBytePos, and is protected by
797 * insertpos_lck.
798 *
799 * 2. Copy the record to the reserved WAL space. This involves finding the
800 * correct WAL buffer containing the reserved space, and copying the
801 * record in place. This can be done concurrently in multiple processes.
802 *
803 * To keep track of which insertions are still in-progress, each concurrent
804 * inserter acquires an insertion lock. In addition to just indicating that
805 * an insertion is in progress, the lock tells others how far the inserter
806 * has progressed. There is a small fixed number of insertion locks,
807 * determined by NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS. When an inserter crosses a page
808 * boundary, it updates the value stored in the lock to the how far it has
809 * inserted, to allow the previous buffer to be flushed.
810 *
811 * Holding onto an insertion lock also protects RedoRecPtr and
812 * fullPageWrites from changing until the insertion is finished.
813 *
814 * Step 2 can usually be done completely in parallel. If the required WAL
815 * page is not initialized yet, you have to grab WALBufMappingLock to
816 * initialize it, but the WAL writer tries to do that ahead of insertions
817 * to avoid that from happening in the critical path.
818 *
819 *----------
820 */
822
823 if (likely(class == WALINSERT_NORMAL))
824 {
826
827 /*
828 * Check to see if my copy of RedoRecPtr is out of date. If so, may
829 * have to go back and have the caller recompute everything. This can
830 * only happen just after a checkpoint, so it's better to be slow in
831 * this case and fast otherwise.
832 *
833 * Also check to see if fullPageWrites was just turned on or there's a
834 * running backup (which forces full-page writes); if we weren't
835 * already doing full-page writes then go back and recompute.
836 *
837 * If we aren't doing full-page writes then RedoRecPtr doesn't
838 * actually affect the contents of the XLOG record, so we'll update
839 * our local copy but not force a recomputation. (If doPageWrites was
840 * just turned off, we could recompute the record without full pages,
841 * but we choose not to bother.)
842 */
843 if (RedoRecPtr != Insert->RedoRecPtr)
844 {
845 Assert(RedoRecPtr < Insert->RedoRecPtr);
846 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr;
847 }
848 doPageWrites = (Insert->fullPageWrites || Insert->runningBackups > 0);
849
850 if (doPageWrites &&
851 (!prevDoPageWrites ||
852 (XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn) && fpw_lsn <= RedoRecPtr)))
853 {
854 /*
855 * Oops, some buffer now needs to be backed up that the caller
856 * didn't back up. Start over.
857 */
860 return InvalidXLogRecPtr;
861 }
862
863 /*
864 * Reserve space for the record in the WAL. This also sets the xl_prev
865 * pointer.
866 */
867 ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
868 &rechdr->xl_prev);
869
870 /* Normal records are always inserted. */
871 inserted = true;
872 }
873 else if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
874 {
875 /*
876 * In order to insert an XLOG_SWITCH record, we need to hold all of
877 * the WAL insertion locks, not just one, so that no one else can
878 * begin inserting a record until we've figured out how much space
879 * remains in the current WAL segment and claimed all of it.
880 *
881 * Nonetheless, this case is simpler than the normal cases handled
882 * below, which must check for changes in doPageWrites and RedoRecPtr.
883 * Those checks are only needed for records that can contain buffer
884 * references, and an XLOG_SWITCH record never does.
885 */
886 Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn));
888 inserted = ReserveXLogSwitch(&StartPos, &EndPos, &rechdr->xl_prev);
889 }
890 else
891 {
893
894 /*
895 * We need to update both the local and shared copies of RedoRecPtr,
896 * which means that we need to hold all the WAL insertion locks.
897 * However, there can't be any buffer references, so as above, we need
898 * not check RedoRecPtr before inserting the record; we just need to
899 * update it afterwards.
900 */
901 Assert(!XLogRecPtrIsValid(fpw_lsn));
903 ReserveXLogInsertLocation(rechdr->xl_tot_len, &StartPos, &EndPos,
904 &rechdr->xl_prev);
905 RedoRecPtr = Insert->RedoRecPtr = StartPos;
906 inserted = true;
907 }
908
909 if (inserted)
910 {
911 /*
912 * Now that xl_prev has been filled in, calculate CRC of the record
913 * header.
914 */
915 rdata_crc = rechdr->xl_crc;
916 COMP_CRC32C(rdata_crc, rechdr, offsetof(XLogRecord, xl_crc));
917 FIN_CRC32C(rdata_crc);
918 rechdr->xl_crc = rdata_crc;
919
920 /*
921 * All the record data, including the header, is now ready to be
922 * inserted. Copy the record in the space reserved.
923 */
925 class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH, rdata,
926 StartPos, EndPos, insertTLI);
927
928 /*
929 * Unless record is flagged as not important, update LSN of last
930 * important record in the current slot. When holding all locks, just
931 * update the first one.
932 */
933 if ((flags & XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT) == 0)
934 {
935 int lockno = holdingAllLocks ? 0 : MyLockNo;
936
937 WALInsertLocks[lockno].l.lastImportantAt = StartPos;
938 }
939 }
940 else
941 {
942 /*
943 * This was an xlog-switch record, but the current insert location was
944 * already exactly at the beginning of a segment, so there was no need
945 * to do anything.
946 */
947 }
948
949 /*
950 * Done! Let others know that we're finished.
951 */
953
955
957
958 /*
959 * Mark top transaction id is logged (if needed) so that we should not try
960 * to log it again with the next WAL record in the current subtransaction.
961 */
962 if (topxid_included)
964
965 /*
966 * Update shared LogwrtRqst.Write, if we crossed page boundary.
967 */
968 if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
969 {
971 /* advance global request to include new block(s) */
972 if (XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write < EndPos)
973 XLogCtl->LogwrtRqst.Write = EndPos;
976 }
977
978 /*
979 * If this was an XLOG_SWITCH record, flush the record and the empty
980 * padding space that fills the rest of the segment, and perform
981 * end-of-segment actions (eg, notifying archiver).
982 */
983 if (class == WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH)
984 {
985 TRACE_POSTGRESQL_WAL_SWITCH();
986 XLogFlush(EndPos);
987
988 /*
989 * Even though we reserved the rest of the segment for us, which is
990 * reflected in EndPos, we return a pointer to just the end of the
991 * xlog-switch record.
992 */
993 if (inserted)
994 {
995 EndPos = StartPos + SizeOfXLogRecord;
996 if (StartPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ != EndPos / XLOG_BLCKSZ)
997 {
998 uint64 offset = XLogSegmentOffset(EndPos, wal_segment_size);
999
1000 if (offset == EndPos % XLOG_BLCKSZ)
1001 EndPos += SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1002 else
1003 EndPos += SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1004 }
1005 }
1006 }
1007
1008#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
1009 if (XLOG_DEBUG)
1010 {
1011 static XLogReaderState *debug_reader = NULL;
1012 XLogRecord *record;
1013 DecodedXLogRecord *decoded;
1015 StringInfoData recordBuf;
1016 char *errormsg = NULL;
1017 MemoryContext oldCxt;
1018
1019 oldCxt = MemoryContextSwitchTo(walDebugCxt);
1020
1022 appendStringInfo(&buf, "INSERT @ %X/%08X: ", LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPos));
1023
1024 /*
1025 * We have to piece together the WAL record data from the XLogRecData
1026 * entries, so that we can pass it to the rm_desc function as one
1027 * contiguous chunk.
1028 */
1029 initStringInfo(&recordBuf);
1030 for (; rdata != NULL; rdata = rdata->next)
1031 appendBinaryStringInfo(&recordBuf, rdata->data, rdata->len);
1032
1033 /* We also need temporary space to decode the record. */
1034 record = (XLogRecord *) recordBuf.data;
1035 decoded = (DecodedXLogRecord *)
1037
1038 if (!debug_reader)
1039 debug_reader = XLogReaderAllocate(wal_segment_size, NULL,
1040 XL_ROUTINE(.page_read = NULL,
1041 .segment_open = NULL,
1042 .segment_close = NULL),
1043 NULL);
1044 if (!debug_reader)
1045 {
1046 appendStringInfoString(&buf, "error decoding record: out of memory while allocating a WAL reading processor");
1047 }
1048 else if (!DecodeXLogRecord(debug_reader,
1049 decoded,
1050 record,
1051 EndPos,
1052 &errormsg))
1053 {
1054 appendStringInfo(&buf, "error decoding record: %s",
1055 errormsg ? errormsg : "no error message");
1056 }
1057 else
1058 {
1059 appendStringInfoString(&buf, " - ");
1060
1061 debug_reader->record = decoded;
1062 xlog_outdesc(&buf, debug_reader);
1063 debug_reader->record = NULL;
1064 }
1065 elog(LOG, "%s", buf.data);
1066
1067 pfree(decoded);
1068 pfree(buf.data);
1069 pfree(recordBuf.data);
1070 MemoryContextSwitchTo(oldCxt);
1071 }
1072#endif
1073
1074 /*
1075 * Update our global variables
1076 */
1077 ProcLastRecPtr = StartPos;
1078 XactLastRecEnd = EndPos;
1079
1080 /* Report WAL traffic to the instrumentation. */
1081 if (inserted)
1082 {
1083 pgWalUsage.wal_bytes += rechdr->xl_tot_len;
1085 pgWalUsage.wal_fpi += num_fpi;
1086 pgWalUsage.wal_fpi_bytes += fpi_bytes;
1087
1088 /* Required for the flush of pending stats WAL data */
1089 pgstat_report_fixed = true;
1090 }
1091
1092 return EndPos;
1093}
#define likely(x)
Definition: c.h:417
#define unlikely(x)
Definition: c.h:418
if(TABLE==NULL||TABLE_index==NULL)
Definition: isn.c:81
void * palloc(Size size)
Definition: mcxt.c:1365
static MemoryContext MemoryContextSwitchTo(MemoryContext context)
Definition: palloc.h:124
void appendBinaryStringInfo(StringInfo str, const void *data, int datalen)
Definition: stringinfo.c:281
void appendStringInfoString(StringInfo str, const char *s)
Definition: stringinfo.c:230
uint64 wal_bytes
Definition: instrument.h:55
int64 wal_fpi
Definition: instrument.h:54
uint64 wal_fpi_bytes
Definition: instrument.h:56
int64 wal_records
Definition: instrument.h:53
DecodedXLogRecord * record
Definition: xlogreader.h:235
pg_crc32c xl_crc
Definition: xlogrecord.h:49
void MarkSubxactTopXidLogged(void)
Definition: xact.c:592
void MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny(void)
Definition: xact.c:542
XLogRecPtr XactLastRecEnd
Definition: xlog.c:256
static void CopyXLogRecordToWAL(int write_len, bool isLogSwitch, XLogRecData *rdata, XLogRecPtr StartPos, XLogRecPtr EndPos, TimeLineID tli)
Definition: xlog.c:1231
static void ReserveXLogInsertLocation(int size, XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition: xlog.c:1114
static bool ReserveXLogSwitch(XLogRecPtr *StartPos, XLogRecPtr *EndPos, XLogRecPtr *PrevPtr)
Definition: xlog.c:1170
XLogReaderState * XLogReaderAllocate(int wal_segment_size, const char *waldir, XLogReaderRoutine *routine, void *private_data)
Definition: xlogreader.c:107
bool DecodeXLogRecord(XLogReaderState *state, DecodedXLogRecord *decoded, XLogRecord *record, XLogRecPtr lsn, char **errormsg)
Definition: xlogreader.c:1682
size_t DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(size_t xl_tot_len)
Definition: xlogreader.c:1649
#define XL_ROUTINE(...)
Definition: xlogreader.h:117
#define XLR_INFO_MASK
Definition: xlogrecord.h:62
void xlog_outdesc(StringInfo buf, XLogReaderState *record)

References appendBinaryStringInfo(), appendStringInfo(), appendStringInfoString(), Assert(), buf, COMP_CRC32C, CopyXLogRecordToWAL(), XLogRecData::data, StringInfoData::data, DecodeXLogRecord(), DecodeXLogRecordRequiredSpace(), doPageWrites, elog, END_CRIT_SECTION, ERROR, FIN_CRC32C, holdingAllLocks, if(), XLogCtlData::info_lck, initStringInfo(), XLogCtlData::Insert, Insert(), XLogCtlData::InsertTimeLineID, InvalidXLogRecPtr, WALInsertLockPadded::l, WALInsertLock::lastImportantAt, XLogRecData::len, likely, LOG, LogwrtResult, XLogCtlData::LogwrtRqst, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, MarkCurrentTransactionIdLoggedIfAny(), MarkSubxactTopXidLogged(), MemoryContextSwitchTo(), MyLockNo, XLogRecData::next, palloc(), pfree(), pgstat_report_fixed, pgWalUsage, ProcLastRecPtr, XLogReaderState::record, RedoRecPtr, RefreshXLogWriteResult, ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), ReserveXLogSwitch(), SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogRecord, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, START_CRIT_SECTION, unlikely, WalUsage::wal_bytes, WalUsage::wal_fpi, WalUsage::wal_fpi_bytes, WalUsage::wal_records, wal_segment_size, WALINSERT_NORMAL, WALINSERT_SPECIAL_CHECKPOINT, WALINSERT_SPECIAL_SWITCH, WALInsertLockAcquire(), WALInsertLockAcquireExclusive(), WALInsertLockRelease(), WALInsertLocks, XLogwrtRqst::Write, XactLastRecEnd, XLogRecord::xl_crc, XLogRecord::xl_info, XLogRecord::xl_prev, XLogRecord::xl_rmid, XL_ROUTINE, XLogRecord::xl_tot_len, XLOG_CHECKPOINT_REDO, XLOG_MARK_UNIMPORTANT, xlog_outdesc(), XLOG_SWITCH, XLogCtl, XLogFlush(), XLogInsertAllowed(), XLogReaderAllocate(), XLogRecPtrIsValid, XLogSegmentOffset, and XLR_INFO_MASK.

Referenced by XLogInsert().

◆ XLogNeedsFlush()

bool XLogNeedsFlush ( XLogRecPtr  record)

Definition at line 3129 of file xlog.c.

3130{
3131 /*
3132 * During recovery, we don't flush WAL but update minRecoveryPoint
3133 * instead. So "needs flush" is taken to mean whether minRecoveryPoint
3134 * would need to be updated.
3135 *
3136 * Using XLogInsertAllowed() rather than RecoveryInProgress() matters for
3137 * the case of an end-of-recovery checkpoint, where WAL data is flushed.
3138 * This check should be consistent with the one in XLogFlush().
3139 */
3140 if (!XLogInsertAllowed())
3141 {
3142 /* Quick exit if already known to be updated or cannot be updated */
3144 return false;
3145
3146 /*
3147 * An invalid minRecoveryPoint means that we need to recover all the
3148 * WAL, i.e., we're doing crash recovery. We never modify the control
3149 * file's value in that case, so we can short-circuit future checks
3150 * here too. This triggers a quick exit path for the startup process,
3151 * which cannot update its local copy of minRecoveryPoint as long as
3152 * it has not replayed all WAL available when doing crash recovery.
3153 */
3155 {
3156 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3157 return false;
3158 }
3159
3160 /*
3161 * Update local copy of minRecoveryPoint. But if the lock is busy,
3162 * just return a conservative guess.
3163 */
3164 if (!LWLockConditionalAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_SHARED))
3165 return true;
3168 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
3169
3170 /*
3171 * Check minRecoveryPoint for any other process than the startup
3172 * process doing crash recovery, which should not update the control
3173 * file value if crash recovery is still running.
3174 */
3176 updateMinRecoveryPoint = false;
3177
3178 /* check again */
3180 return false;
3181 else
3182 return true;
3183 }
3184
3185 /* Quick exit if already known flushed */
3186 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3187 return false;
3188
3189 /* read LogwrtResult and update local state */
3191
3192 /* check again */
3193 if (record <= LogwrtResult.Flush)
3194 return false;
3195
3196 return true;
3197}
bool LWLockConditionalAcquire(LWLock *lock, LWLockMode mode)
Definition: lwlock.c:1345

References ControlFile, XLogwrtResult::Flush, InRecovery, LocalMinRecoveryPoint, LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI, LogwrtResult, LW_SHARED, LWLockConditionalAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), ControlFileData::minRecoveryPoint, ControlFileData::minRecoveryPointTLI, RefreshXLogWriteResult, updateMinRecoveryPoint, XLogInsertAllowed(), and XLogRecPtrIsValid.

Referenced by GetVictimBuffer(), SetHintBits(), and XLogFlush().

◆ XLogPutNextOid()

void XLogPutNextOid ( Oid  nextOid)

Definition at line 8091 of file xlog.c.

8092{
8094 XLogRegisterData(&nextOid, sizeof(Oid));
8095 (void) XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_NEXTOID);
8096
8097 /*
8098 * We need not flush the NEXTOID record immediately, because any of the
8099 * just-allocated OIDs could only reach disk as part of a tuple insert or
8100 * update that would have its own XLOG record that must follow the NEXTOID
8101 * record. Therefore, the standard buffer LSN interlock applied to those
8102 * records will ensure no such OID reaches disk before the NEXTOID record
8103 * does.
8104 *
8105 * Note, however, that the above statement only covers state "within" the
8106 * database. When we use a generated OID as a file or directory name, we
8107 * are in a sense violating the basic WAL rule, because that filesystem
8108 * change may reach disk before the NEXTOID WAL record does. The impact
8109 * of this is that if a database crash occurs immediately afterward, we
8110 * might after restart re-generate the same OID and find that it conflicts
8111 * with the leftover file or directory. But since for safety's sake we
8112 * always loop until finding a nonconflicting filename, this poses no real
8113 * problem in practice. See pgsql-hackers discussion 27-Sep-2006.
8114 */
8115}

References XLOG_NEXTOID, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogInsert(), and XLogRegisterData().

Referenced by GetNewObjectId().

◆ XLogRecPtrToBytePos()

static uint64 XLogRecPtrToBytePos ( XLogRecPtr  ptr)
static

Definition at line 1947 of file xlog.c.

1948{
1949 uint64 fullsegs;
1950 uint32 fullpages;
1951 uint32 offset;
1952 uint64 result;
1953
1954 XLByteToSeg(ptr, fullsegs, wal_segment_size);
1955
1956 fullpages = (XLogSegmentOffset(ptr, wal_segment_size)) / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1957 offset = ptr % XLOG_BLCKSZ;
1958
1959 if (fullpages == 0)
1960 {
1961 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment;
1962 if (offset > 0)
1963 {
1964 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogLongPHD);
1965 result += offset - SizeOfXLogLongPHD;
1966 }
1967 }
1968 else
1969 {
1970 result = fullsegs * UsableBytesInSegment +
1971 (XLOG_BLCKSZ - SizeOfXLogLongPHD) + /* account for first page */
1972 (fullpages - 1) * UsableBytesInPage; /* full pages */
1973 if (offset > 0)
1974 {
1975 Assert(offset >= SizeOfXLogShortPHD);
1976 result += offset - SizeOfXLogShortPHD;
1977 }
1978 }
1979
1980 return result;
1981}

References Assert(), SizeOfXLogLongPHD, SizeOfXLogShortPHD, UsableBytesInPage, UsableBytesInSegment, wal_segment_size, XLByteToSeg, and XLogSegmentOffset.

Referenced by ReserveXLogInsertLocation(), ReserveXLogSwitch(), and StartupXLOG().

◆ XLogReportParameters()

static void XLogReportParameters ( void  )
static

Definition at line 8171 of file xlog.c.

8172{
8181 {
8182 /*
8183 * The change in number of backend slots doesn't need to be WAL-logged
8184 * if archiving is not enabled, as you can't start archive recovery
8185 * with wal_level=minimal anyway. We don't really care about the
8186 * values in pg_control either if wal_level=minimal, but seems better
8187 * to keep them up-to-date to avoid confusion.
8188 */
8190 {
8191 xl_parameter_change xlrec;
8192 XLogRecPtr recptr;
8193
8199 xlrec.wal_level = wal_level;
8202
8204 XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xlrec));
8205
8206 recptr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE);
8207 XLogFlush(recptr);
8208 }
8209
8210 LWLockAcquire(ControlFileLock, LW_EXCLUSIVE);
8211
8221
8222 LWLockRelease(ControlFileLock);
8223 }
8224}

References ControlFile, LW_EXCLUSIVE, LWLockAcquire(), LWLockRelease(), max_locks_per_xact, xl_parameter_change::max_locks_per_xact, ControlFileData::max_locks_per_xact, max_prepared_xacts, xl_parameter_change::max_prepared_xacts, ControlFileData::max_prepared_xacts, max_wal_senders, xl_parameter_change::max_wal_senders, ControlFileData::max_wal_senders, max_worker_processes, xl_parameter_change::max_worker_processes, ControlFileData::max_worker_processes, MaxConnections, xl_parameter_change::MaxConnections, ControlFileData::MaxConnections, track_commit_timestamp, xl_parameter_change::track_commit_timestamp, ControlFileData::track_commit_timestamp, UpdateControlFile(), wal_level, xl_parameter_change::wal_level, ControlFileData::wal_level, wal_log_hints, xl_parameter_change::wal_log_hints, ControlFileData::wal_log_hints, XLOG_PARAMETER_CHANGE, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogFlush(), XLogInsert(), XLogIsNeeded, and XLogRegisterData().

Referenced by StartupXLOG().

◆ XLogRestorePoint()

XLogRecPtr XLogRestorePoint ( const char *  rpName)

Definition at line 8146 of file xlog.c.

8147{
8148 XLogRecPtr RecPtr;
8149 xl_restore_point xlrec;
8150
8151 xlrec.rp_time = GetCurrentTimestamp();
8152 strlcpy(xlrec.rp_name, rpName, MAXFNAMELEN);
8153
8155 XLogRegisterData(&xlrec, sizeof(xl_restore_point));
8156
8157 RecPtr = XLogInsert(RM_XLOG_ID, XLOG_RESTORE_POINT);
8158
8159 ereport(LOG,
8160 errmsg("restore point \"%s\" created at %X/%08X",
8161 rpName, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(RecPtr)));
8162
8163 return RecPtr;
8164}
char rp_name[MAXFNAMELEN]
TimestampTz rp_time

References ereport, errmsg(), GetCurrentTimestamp(), LOG, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, MAXFNAMELEN, xl_restore_point::rp_name, xl_restore_point::rp_time, strlcpy(), XLOG_RESTORE_POINT, XLogBeginInsert(), XLogInsert(), and XLogRegisterData().

Referenced by pg_create_restore_point().

◆ XLogSetAsyncXactLSN()

void XLogSetAsyncXactLSN ( XLogRecPtr  asyncXactLSN)

Definition at line 2612 of file xlog.c.

2613{
2614 XLogRecPtr WriteRqstPtr = asyncXactLSN;
2615 bool sleeping;
2616 bool wakeup = false;
2617 XLogRecPtr prevAsyncXactLSN;
2618
2620 sleeping = XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping;
2621 prevAsyncXactLSN = XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN;
2622 if (XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN < asyncXactLSN)
2623 XLogCtl->asyncXactLSN = asyncXactLSN;
2625
2626 /*
2627 * If somebody else already called this function with a more aggressive
2628 * LSN, they will have done what we needed (and perhaps more).
2629 */
2630 if (asyncXactLSN <= prevAsyncXactLSN)
2631 return;
2632
2633 /*
2634 * If the WALWriter is sleeping, kick it to make it come out of low-power
2635 * mode, so that this async commit will reach disk within the expected
2636 * amount of time. Otherwise, determine whether it has enough WAL
2637 * available to flush, the same way that XLogBackgroundFlush() does.
2638 */
2639 if (sleeping)
2640 wakeup = true;
2641 else
2642 {
2643 int flushblocks;
2644
2646
2647 flushblocks =
2648 WriteRqstPtr / XLOG_BLCKSZ - LogwrtResult.Flush / XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2649
2650 if (WalWriterFlushAfter == 0 || flushblocks >= WalWriterFlushAfter)
2651 wakeup = true;
2652 }
2653
2654 if (wakeup)
2655 {
2656 volatile PROC_HDR *procglobal = ProcGlobal;
2657 ProcNumber walwriterProc = procglobal->walwriterProc;
2658
2659 if (walwriterProc != INVALID_PROC_NUMBER)
2660 SetLatch(&GetPGProcByNumber(walwriterProc)->procLatch);
2661 }
2662}
void SetLatch(Latch *latch)
Definition: latch.c:290
#define GetPGProcByNumber(n)
Definition: proc.h:440
#define INVALID_PROC_NUMBER
Definition: procnumber.h:26
int ProcNumber
Definition: procnumber.h:24
PROC_HDR * ProcGlobal
Definition: proc.c:79
Definition: proc.h:386
ProcNumber walwriterProc
Definition: proc.h:424
static TimestampTz wakeup[NUM_WALRCV_WAKEUPS]
Definition: walreceiver.c:130

References XLogCtlData::asyncXactLSN, XLogwrtResult::Flush, GetPGProcByNumber, XLogCtlData::info_lck, INVALID_PROC_NUMBER, LogwrtResult, ProcGlobal, RefreshXLogWriteResult, SetLatch(), SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, wakeup, WalWriterFlushAfter, PROC_HDR::walwriterProc, XLogCtlData::WalWriterSleeping, and XLogCtl.

Referenced by AbortTransaction(), LogCurrentRunningXacts(), RecordTransactionAbort(), and RecordTransactionCommit().

◆ XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN()

void XLogSetReplicationSlotMinimumLSN ( XLogRecPtr  lsn)

◆ XLOGShmemInit()

void XLOGShmemInit ( void  )

Definition at line 4976 of file xlog.c.

4977{
4978 bool foundCFile,
4979 foundXLog;
4980 char *allocptr;
4981 int i;
4982 ControlFileData *localControlFile;
4983
4984#ifdef WAL_DEBUG
4985
4986 /*
4987 * Create a memory context for WAL debugging that's exempt from the normal
4988 * "no pallocs in critical section" rule. Yes, that can lead to a PANIC if
4989 * an allocation fails, but wal_debug is not for production use anyway.
4990 */
4991 if (walDebugCxt == NULL)
4992 {
4994 "WAL Debug",
4996 MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(walDebugCxt, true);
4997 }
4998#endif
4999
5000
5001 XLogCtl = (XLogCtlData *)
5002 ShmemInitStruct("XLOG Ctl", XLOGShmemSize(), &foundXLog);
5003
5004 localControlFile = ControlFile;
5006 ShmemInitStruct("Control File", sizeof(ControlFileData), &foundCFile);
5007
5008 if (foundCFile || foundXLog)
5009 {
5010 /* both should be present or neither */
5011 Assert(foundCFile && foundXLog);
5012
5013 /* Initialize local copy of WALInsertLocks */
5015
5016 if (localControlFile)
5017 pfree(localControlFile);
5018 return;
5019 }
5020 memset(XLogCtl, 0, sizeof(XLogCtlData));
5021
5022 /*
5023 * Already have read control file locally, unless in bootstrap mode. Move
5024 * contents into shared memory.
5025 */
5026 if (localControlFile)
5027 {
5028 memcpy(ControlFile, localControlFile, sizeof(ControlFileData));
5029 pfree(localControlFile);
5030 }
5031
5032 /*
5033 * Since XLogCtlData contains XLogRecPtr fields, its sizeof should be a
5034 * multiple of the alignment for same, so no extra alignment padding is
5035 * needed here.
5036 */
5037 allocptr = ((char *) XLogCtl) + sizeof(XLogCtlData);
5038 XLogCtl->xlblocks = (pg_atomic_uint64 *) allocptr;
5039 allocptr += sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64) * XLOGbuffers;
5040
5041 for (i = 0; i < XLOGbuffers; i++)
5042 {
5044 }
5045
5046 /* WAL insertion locks. Ensure they're aligned to the full padded size */
5047 allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) -
5048 ((uintptr_t) allocptr) % sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded);
5050 (WALInsertLockPadded *) allocptr;
5051 allocptr += sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded) * NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS;
5052
5053 for (i = 0; i < NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS; i++)
5054 {
5055 LWLockInitialize(&WALInsertLocks[i].l.lock, LWTRANCHE_WAL_INSERT);
5058 }
5059
5060 /*
5061 * Align the start of the page buffers to a full xlog block size boundary.
5062 * This simplifies some calculations in XLOG insertion. It is also
5063 * required for O_DIRECT.
5064 */
5065 allocptr = (char *) TYPEALIGN(XLOG_BLCKSZ, allocptr);
5066 XLogCtl->pages = allocptr;
5067 memset(XLogCtl->pages, 0, (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ * XLOGbuffers);
5068
5069 /*
5070 * Do basic initialization of XLogCtl shared data. (StartupXLOG will fill
5071 * in additional info.)
5072 */
5076 XLogCtl->WalWriterSleeping = false;
5077
5084}
static void pg_atomic_init_u64(volatile pg_atomic_uint64 *ptr, uint64 val)
Definition: atomics.h:453
#define TYPEALIGN(ALIGNVAL, LEN)
Definition: c.h:817
struct pg_atomic_uint64 pg_atomic_uint64
void LWLockInitialize(LWLock *lock, int tranche_id)
Definition: lwlock.c:698
MemoryContext TopMemoryContext
Definition: mcxt.c:166
void MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(MemoryContext context, bool allow)
Definition: mcxt.c:740
#define AllocSetContextCreate
Definition: memutils.h:129
#define ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES
Definition: memutils.h:160
void * ShmemInitStruct(const char *name, Size size, bool *foundPtr)
Definition: shmem.c:389
#define SpinLockInit(lock)
Definition: spin.h:57
int XLogCacheBlck
Definition: xlog.c:495
WALInsertLockPadded * WALInsertLocks
Definition: xlog.c:446
slock_t insertpos_lck
Definition: xlog.c:400
union WALInsertLockPadded WALInsertLockPadded
Size XLOGShmemSize(void)
Definition: xlog.c:4926
struct XLogCtlData XLogCtlData

References ALLOCSET_DEFAULT_SIZES, AllocSetContextCreate, Assert(), ControlFile, i, XLogCtlData::info_lck, XLogCtlData::Insert, XLogCtlInsert::insertpos_lck, XLogCtlData::InstallXLogFileSegmentActive, InvalidXLogRecPtr, WALInsertLockPadded::l, WALInsertLock::lastImportantAt, XLogCtlData::logFlushResult, XLogCtlData::logInsertResult, XLogCtlData::logWriteResult, LWLockInitialize(), MemoryContextAllowInCriticalSection(), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, XLogCtlData::pages, pfree(), pg_atomic_init_u64(), RECOVERY_STATE_CRASH, XLogCtlData::SharedRecoveryState, ShmemInitStruct(), SpinLockInit, TopMemoryContext, TYPEALIGN, XLogCtlData::unloggedLSN, XLogCtlInsert::WALInsertLocks, WALInsertLocks, XLogCtlData::WalWriterSleeping, XLogCtlData::xlblocks, XLOGbuffers, XLogCtlData::XLogCacheBlck, XLogCtl, and XLOGShmemSize().

Referenced by CreateOrAttachShmemStructs().

◆ XLOGShmemSize()

Size XLOGShmemSize ( void  )

Definition at line 4926 of file xlog.c.

4927{
4928 Size size;
4929
4930 /*
4931 * If the value of wal_buffers is -1, use the preferred auto-tune value.
4932 * This isn't an amazingly clean place to do this, but we must wait till
4933 * NBuffers has received its final value, and must do it before using the
4934 * value of XLOGbuffers to do anything important.
4935 *
4936 * We prefer to report this value's source as PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT.
4937 * However, if the DBA explicitly set wal_buffers = -1 in the config file,
4938 * then PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT will fail to override that and we must force
4939 * the matter with PGC_S_OVERRIDE.
4940 */
4941 if (XLOGbuffers == -1)
4942 {
4943 char buf[32];
4944
4945 snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", XLOGChooseNumBuffers());
4946 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4948 if (XLOGbuffers == -1) /* failed to apply it? */
4949 SetConfigOption("wal_buffers", buf, PGC_POSTMASTER,
4951 }
4952 Assert(XLOGbuffers > 0);
4953
4954 /* XLogCtl */
4955 size = sizeof(XLogCtlData);
4956
4957 /* WAL insertion locks, plus alignment */
4958 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(WALInsertLockPadded), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS + 1));
4959 /* xlblocks array */
4960 size = add_size(size, mul_size(sizeof(pg_atomic_uint64), XLOGbuffers));
4961 /* extra alignment padding for XLOG I/O buffers */
4962 size = add_size(size, Max(XLOG_BLCKSZ, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE));
4963 /* and the buffers themselves */
4964 size = add_size(size, mul_size(XLOG_BLCKSZ, XLOGbuffers));
4965
4966 /*
4967 * Note: we don't count ControlFileData, it comes out of the "slop factor"
4968 * added by CreateSharedMemoryAndSemaphores. This lets us use this
4969 * routine again below to compute the actual allocation size.
4970 */
4971
4972 return size;
4973}
#define Max(x, y)
Definition: c.h:1010
@ PGC_S_OVERRIDE
Definition: guc.h:123
@ PGC_POSTMASTER
Definition: guc.h:74
#define PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE
Size add_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition: shmem.c:495
Size mul_size(Size s1, Size s2)
Definition: shmem.c:510

References add_size(), Assert(), buf, Max, mul_size(), NUM_XLOGINSERT_LOCKS, PG_IO_ALIGN_SIZE, PGC_POSTMASTER, PGC_S_DYNAMIC_DEFAULT, PGC_S_OVERRIDE, SetConfigOption(), snprintf, XLOGbuffers, and XLOGChooseNumBuffers().

Referenced by CalculateShmemSize(), and XLOGShmemInit().

◆ XLogShutdownWalRcv()

void XLogShutdownWalRcv ( void  )

Definition at line 9535 of file xlog.c.

9536{
9538
9541}
#define AmStartupProcess()
Definition: miscadmin.h:390
void ShutdownWalRcv(void)
void ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(void)
Definition: xlog.c:9554

References AmStartupProcess, Assert(), IsUnderPostmaster, ResetInstallXLogFileSegmentActive(), and ShutdownWalRcv().

Referenced by FinishWalRecovery(), and WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable().

◆ XLogWrite()

static void XLogWrite ( XLogwrtRqst  WriteRqst,
TimeLineID  tli,
bool  flexible 
)
static

Definition at line 2307 of file xlog.c.

2308{
2309 bool ispartialpage;
2310 bool last_iteration;
2311 bool finishing_seg;
2312 int curridx;
2313 int npages;
2314 int startidx;
2315 uint32 startoffset;
2316
2317 /* We should always be inside a critical section here */
2319
2320 /*
2321 * Update local LogwrtResult (caller probably did this already, but...)
2322 */
2324
2325 /*
2326 * Since successive pages in the xlog cache are consecutively allocated,
2327 * we can usually gather multiple pages together and issue just one
2328 * write() call. npages is the number of pages we have determined can be
2329 * written together; startidx is the cache block index of the first one,
2330 * and startoffset is the file offset at which it should go. The latter
2331 * two variables are only valid when npages > 0, but we must initialize
2332 * all of them to keep the compiler quiet.
2333 */
2334 npages = 0;
2335 startidx = 0;
2336 startoffset = 0;
2337
2338 /*
2339 * Within the loop, curridx is the cache block index of the page to
2340 * consider writing. Begin at the buffer containing the next unwritten
2341 * page, or last partially written page.
2342 */
2344
2345 while (LogwrtResult.Write < WriteRqst.Write)
2346 {
2347 /*
2348 * Make sure we're not ahead of the insert process. This could happen
2349 * if we're passed a bogus WriteRqst.Write that is past the end of the
2350 * last page that's been initialized by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer.
2351 */
2352 XLogRecPtr EndPtr = pg_atomic_read_u64(&XLogCtl->xlblocks[curridx]);
2353
2354 if (LogwrtResult.Write >= EndPtr)
2355 elog(PANIC, "xlog write request %X/%08X is past end of log %X/%08X",
2357 LSN_FORMAT_ARGS(EndPtr));
2358
2359 /* Advance LogwrtResult.Write to end of current buffer page */
2360 LogwrtResult.Write = EndPtr;
2361 ispartialpage = WriteRqst.Write < LogwrtResult.Write;
2362
2365 {
2366 /*
2367 * Switch to new logfile segment. We cannot have any pending
2368 * pages here (since we dump what we have at segment end).
2369 */
2370 Assert(npages == 0);
2371 if (openLogFile >= 0)
2372 XLogFileClose();
2375 openLogTLI = tli;
2376
2377 /* create/use new log file */
2380 }
2381
2382 /* Make sure we have the current logfile open */
2383 if (openLogFile < 0)
2384 {
2387 openLogTLI = tli;
2390 }
2391
2392 /* Add current page to the set of pending pages-to-dump */
2393 if (npages == 0)
2394 {
2395 /* first of group */
2396 startidx = curridx;
2397 startoffset = XLogSegmentOffset(LogwrtResult.Write - XLOG_BLCKSZ,
2399 }
2400 npages++;
2401
2402 /*
2403 * Dump the set if this will be the last loop iteration, or if we are
2404 * at the last page of the cache area (since the next page won't be
2405 * contiguous in memory), or if we are at the end of the logfile
2406 * segment.
2407 */
2408 last_iteration = WriteRqst.Write <= LogwrtResult.Write;
2409
2410 finishing_seg = !ispartialpage &&
2411 (startoffset + npages * XLOG_BLCKSZ) >= wal_segment_size;
2412
2413 if (last_iteration ||
2414 curridx == XLogCtl->XLogCacheBlck ||
2415 finishing_seg)
2416 {
2417 char *from;
2418 Size nbytes;
2419 Size nleft;
2420 ssize_t written;
2422
2423 /* OK to write the page(s) */
2424 from = XLogCtl->pages + startidx * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2425 nbytes = npages * (Size) XLOG_BLCKSZ;
2426 nleft = nbytes;
2427 do
2428 {
2429 errno = 0;
2430
2431 /*
2432 * Measure I/O timing to write WAL data, for pg_stat_io.
2433 */
2435
2436 pgstat_report_wait_start(WAIT_EVENT_WAL_WRITE);
2437 written = pg_pwrite(openLogFile, from, nleft, startoffset);
2439
2441 IOOP_WRITE, start, 1, written);
2442
2443 if (written <= 0)
2444 {
2445 char xlogfname[MAXFNAMELEN];
2446 int save_errno;
2447
2448 if (errno == EINTR)
2449 continue;
2450
2451 save_errno = errno;
2452 XLogFileName(xlogfname, tli, openLogSegNo,
2454 errno = save_errno;
2455 ereport(PANIC,
2457 errmsg("could not write to log file \"%s\" at offset %u, length %zu: %m",
2458 xlogfname, startoffset, nleft)));
2459 }
2460 nleft -= written;
2461 from += written;
2462 startoffset += written;
2463 } while (nleft > 0);
2464
2465 npages = 0;
2466
2467 /*
2468 * If we just wrote the whole last page of a logfile segment,
2469 * fsync the segment immediately. This avoids having to go back
2470 * and re-open prior segments when an fsync request comes along
2471 * later. Doing it here ensures that one and only one backend will
2472 * perform this fsync.
2473 *
2474 * This is also the right place to notify the Archiver that the
2475 * segment is ready to copy to archival storage, and to update the
2476 * timer for archive_timeout, and to signal for a checkpoint if
2477 * too many logfile segments have been used since the last
2478 * checkpoint.
2479 */
2480 if (finishing_seg)
2481 {
2483
2484 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2486
2487 LogwrtResult.Flush = LogwrtResult.Write; /* end of page */
2488
2489 if (XLogArchivingActive())
2491
2492 XLogCtl->lastSegSwitchTime = (pg_time_t) time(NULL);
2494
2495 /*
2496 * Request a checkpoint if we've consumed too much xlog since
2497 * the last one. For speed, we first check using the local
2498 * copy of RedoRecPtr, which might be out of date; if it looks
2499 * like a checkpoint is needed, forcibly update RedoRecPtr and
2500 * recheck.
2501 */
2503 {
2504 (void) GetRedoRecPtr();
2507 }
2508 }
2509 }
2510
2511 if (ispartialpage)
2512 {
2513 /* Only asked to write a partial page */
2514 LogwrtResult.Write = WriteRqst.Write;
2515 break;
2516 }
2517 curridx = NextBufIdx(curridx);
2518
2519 /* If flexible, break out of loop as soon as we wrote something */
2520 if (flexible && npages == 0)
2521 break;
2522 }
2523
2524 Assert(npages == 0);
2525
2526 /*
2527 * If asked to flush, do so
2528 */
2529 if (LogwrtResult.Flush < WriteRqst.Flush &&
2531 {
2532 /*
2533 * Could get here without iterating above loop, in which case we might
2534 * have no open file or the wrong one. However, we do not need to
2535 * fsync more than one file.
2536 */
2539 {
2540 if (openLogFile >= 0 &&
2543 XLogFileClose();
2544 if (openLogFile < 0)
2545 {
2548 openLogTLI = tli;
2551 }
2552
2554 }
2555
2556 /* signal that we need to wakeup walsenders later */
2558
2560 }
2561
2562 /*
2563 * Update shared-memory status
2564 *
2565 * We make sure that the shared 'request' values do not fall behind the
2566 * 'result' values. This is not absolutely essential, but it saves some
2567 * code in a couple of places.
2568 */
2575
2576 /*
2577 * We write Write first, bar, then Flush. When reading, the opposite must
2578 * be done (with a matching barrier in between), so that we always see a
2579 * Flush value that trails behind the Write value seen.
2580 */
2584
2585#ifdef USE_ASSERT_CHECKING
2586 {
2590
2596
2597 /* WAL written to disk is always ahead of WAL flushed */
2598 Assert(Write >= Flush);
2599
2600 /* WAL inserted to buffers is always ahead of WAL written */
2601 Assert(Insert >= Write);
2602 }
2603#endif
2604}
void ReserveExternalFD(void)
Definition: fd.c:1203
volatile uint32 CritSectionCount
Definition: globals.c:45
XLogRecPtr Flush
Definition: walreceiver.c:112
XLogRecPtr Write
Definition: walreceiver.c:111
#define WalSndWakeupRequest()
Definition: walsender.h:58
#define EINTR
Definition: win32_port.h:361
XLogRecPtr GetRedoRecPtr(void)
Definition: xlog.c:6507
int XLogFileOpen(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition: xlog.c:3639
#define NextBufIdx(idx)
Definition: xlog.c:585
void issue_xlog_fsync(int fd, XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition: xlog.c:8757
bool XLogCheckpointNeeded(XLogSegNo new_segno)
Definition: xlog.c:2283
void XLogArchiveNotifySeg(XLogSegNo segno, TimeLineID tli)
Definition: xlogarchive.c:492

References Assert(), CHECKPOINT_CAUSE_XLOG, CritSectionCount, EINTR, elog, ereport, errcode_for_file_access(), errmsg(), XLogwrtRqst::Flush, XLogwrtResult::Flush, Flush, GetRedoRecPtr(), XLogCtlData::info_lck, Insert(), IOCONTEXT_NORMAL, IOOBJECT_WAL, IOOP_WRITE, issue_xlog_fsync(), IsUnderPostmaster, XLogCtlData::lastSegSwitchLSN, XLogCtlData::lastSegSwitchTime, XLogCtlData::logFlushResult, XLogCtlData::logInsertResult, XLogCtlData::logWriteResult, LogwrtResult, XLogCtlData::LogwrtRqst, LSN_FORMAT_ARGS, MAXFNAMELEN, NextBufIdx, openLogFile, openLogSegNo, openLogTLI, XLogCtlData::pages, PANIC, pg_atomic_read_u64(), pg_atomic_write_u64(), pg_pwrite, pg_read_barrier, pg_write_barrier, pgstat_count_io_op_time(), pgstat_prepare_io_time(), pgstat_report_wait_end(), pgstat_report_wait_start(), RefreshXLogWriteResult, RequestCheckpoint(), ReserveExternalFD(), SpinLockAcquire, SpinLockRelease, start, track_wal_io_timing, wal_segment_size, wal_sync_method, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN, WAL_SYNC_METHOD_OPEN_DSYNC, WalSndWakeupRequest, XLogwrtRqst::Write, XLogwrtResult::Write, Write, XLogCtlData::xlblocks, XLByteInPrevSeg, XLByteToPrevSeg, XLogArchiveNotifySeg(), XLogArchivingActive, XLogCtlData::XLogCacheBlck, XLogCheckpointNeeded(), XLogCtl, XLogFileClose(), XLogFileInit(), XLogFileName(), XLogFileOpen(), XLogRecPtrToBufIdx, and XLogSegmentOffset.

Referenced by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), XLogBackgroundFlush(), and XLogFlush().

Variable Documentation

◆ archive_mode_options

const struct config_enum_entry archive_mode_options[]
Initial value:
= {
{"always", ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS, false},
{"on", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, false},
{"off", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, false},
{"true", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
{"false", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
{"yes", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
{"no", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
{"1", ARCHIVE_MODE_ON, true},
{"0", ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF, true},
{NULL, 0, false}
}
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ALWAYS
Definition: xlog.h:67
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_OFF
Definition: xlog.h:65
@ ARCHIVE_MODE_ON
Definition: xlog.h:66

Definition at line 193 of file xlog.c.

◆ check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred

bool check_wal_consistency_checking_deferred = false
static

Definition at line 168 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by check_wal_consistency_checking(), and InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().

◆ CheckPointDistanceEstimate

double CheckPointDistanceEstimate = 0
static

Definition at line 161 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by LogCheckpointEnd(), UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate(), and XLOGfileslop().

◆ CheckPointSegments

int CheckPointSegments

◆ CheckpointStats

◆ CommitDelay

int CommitDelay = 0

Definition at line 134 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by XLogFlush().

◆ CommitSiblings

int CommitSiblings = 5

Definition at line 135 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by XLogFlush().

◆ ControlFile

◆ doPageWrites

bool doPageWrites
static

◆ EnableHotStandby

◆ fullPageWrites

bool fullPageWrites = true

Definition at line 124 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by BootStrapXLOG(), and UpdateFullPageWrites().

◆ holdingAllLocks

bool holdingAllLocks = false
static

◆ lastFullPageWrites

bool lastFullPageWrites
static

Definition at line 219 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by StartupXLOG(), and xlog_redo().

◆ LocalMinRecoveryPoint

XLogRecPtr LocalMinRecoveryPoint
static

◆ LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI

TimeLineID LocalMinRecoveryPointTLI
static

◆ LocalRecoveryInProgress

bool LocalRecoveryInProgress = true
static

Definition at line 226 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by RecoveryInProgress().

◆ LocalXLogInsertAllowed

int LocalXLogInsertAllowed = -1
static

Definition at line 238 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by CreateCheckPoint(), LocalSetXLogInsertAllowed(), and XLogInsertAllowed().

◆ log_checkpoints

bool log_checkpoints = true

◆ LogwrtResult

◆ max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb

int max_slot_wal_keep_size_mb = -1

Definition at line 137 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by KeepLogSeg(), and pg_get_replication_slots().

◆ max_wal_size_mb

int max_wal_size_mb = 1024

◆ min_wal_size_mb

int min_wal_size_mb = 80

Definition at line 117 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by ReadControlFile(), and XLOGfileslop().

◆ MyLockNo

int MyLockNo = 0
static

◆ openLogFile

int openLogFile = -1
static

◆ openLogSegNo

XLogSegNo openLogSegNo = 0
static

Definition at line 637 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by assign_wal_sync_method(), XLogBackgroundFlush(), XLogFileClose(), and XLogWrite().

◆ openLogTLI

TimeLineID openLogTLI = 0
static

Definition at line 638 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by assign_wal_sync_method(), BootStrapXLOG(), XLogFileClose(), and XLogWrite().

◆ PrevCheckPointDistance

double PrevCheckPointDistance = 0
static

Definition at line 162 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by LogCheckpointEnd(), and UpdateCheckPointDistanceEstimate().

◆ ProcLastRecPtr

◆ RedoRecPtr

◆ sessionBackupState

SessionBackupState sessionBackupState = SESSION_BACKUP_NONE
static

◆ track_wal_io_timing

◆ updateMinRecoveryPoint

bool updateMinRecoveryPoint = true
static

Definition at line 649 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by SwitchIntoArchiveRecovery(), UpdateMinRecoveryPoint(), and XLogNeedsFlush().

◆ UsableBytesInSegment

int UsableBytesInSegment
static

◆ wal_compression

int wal_compression = WAL_COMPRESSION_NONE

Definition at line 126 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by XLogCompressBackupBlock(), and XLogRecordAssemble().

◆ wal_consistency_checking

bool* wal_consistency_checking = NULL

Definition at line 128 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by assign_wal_consistency_checking(), and XLogRecordAssemble().

◆ wal_consistency_checking_string

char* wal_consistency_checking_string = NULL

Definition at line 127 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by InitializeWalConsistencyChecking().

◆ wal_decode_buffer_size

int wal_decode_buffer_size = 512 * 1024

Definition at line 138 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by InitWalRecovery().

◆ wal_init_zero

bool wal_init_zero = true

Definition at line 129 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by XLogFileInitInternal().

◆ wal_keep_size_mb

int wal_keep_size_mb = 0

Definition at line 118 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by KeepLogSeg(), and pg_get_replication_slots().

◆ wal_level

◆ wal_log_hints

bool wal_log_hints = false

Definition at line 125 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by InitControlFile(), and XLogReportParameters().

◆ wal_recycle

bool wal_recycle = true

Definition at line 130 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by RemoveXlogFile().

◆ wal_retrieve_retry_interval

int wal_retrieve_retry_interval = 5000

Definition at line 136 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by ApplyLauncherMain(), launch_sync_worker(), and WaitForWALToBecomeAvailable().

◆ wal_segment_size

int wal_segment_size = DEFAULT_XLOG_SEG_SIZE

Definition at line 145 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by AdvanceXLInsertBuffer(), assign_wal_sync_method(), BootStrapXLOG(), build_backup_content(), CalculateCheckpointSegments(), CheckArchiveTimeout(), CheckXLogRemoved(), CleanupAfterArchiveRecovery(), copy_replication_slot(), CopyXLogRecordToWAL(), CreateCheckPoint(), CreateOverwriteContrecordRecord(), CreateRestartPoint(), do_pg_backup_stop(), ExecuteRecoveryCommand(), FinishWalRecovery(), GetOldestUnsummarizedLSN(), GetWALAvailability(), GetXLogBuffer(), InitWalRecovery(), InitXLogReaderState(), InstallXLogFileSegment(), InvalidateObsoleteReplicationSlots(), IsCheckpointOnSchedule(), issue_xlog_fsync(), KeepLogSeg(), LogicalConfirmReceivedLocation(), MaybeRemoveOldWalSummaries(), perform_base_backup(), pg_control_checkpoint(), pg_get_replication_slots(), pg_split_walfile_name(), pg_walfile_name(), pg_walfile_name_offset(), PreallocXlogFiles(), ReadControlFile(), ReadRecord(), RemoveNonParentXlogFiles(), RemoveOldXlogFiles(), ReorderBufferRestoreChanges(), ReorderBufferRestoreCleanup(), ReorderBufferSerializedPath(), ReorderBufferSerializeTXN(), ReplicationSlotReserveWal(), RequestXLogStreaming(), reserve_wal_for_local_slot(), ReserveXLogSwitch(), RestoreArchivedFile(), StartReplication(), StartupDecodingContext(), SummarizeWAL(), UpdateLastRemovedPtr(), WALReadRaiseError(), WalReceiverMain(), WalSndSegmentOpen(), WriteControlFile(), XLogArchiveNotifySeg(), XLogBackgroundFlush(), XLogBytePosToEndRecPtr(), XLogBytePosToRecPtr(), XLogCheckpointNeeded(), XLOGChooseNumBuffers(), XLogFileClose(), XLogFileCopy(), XLogFileInitInternal(), XLogFileOpen(), XLogFileRead(), XLogFileReadAnyTLI(), XLOGfileslop(), XLogGetOldestSegno(), XLogInitNewTimeline(), XLogInsertRecord(), XLogPageRead(), XLogReaderAllocate(), XlogReadTwoPhaseData(), XLogRecPtrToBytePos(), XLogWalRcvClose(), XLogWalRcvWrite(), and XLogWrite().

◆ wal_sync_method

◆ wal_sync_method_options

const struct config_enum_entry wal_sync_method_options[]
Initial value:
= {
{"fsync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FSYNC, false},
{"fdatasync", WAL_SYNC_METHOD_FDATASYNC, false},
{NULL, 0, false}
}

Definition at line 173 of file xlog.c.

◆ WALInsertLocks

◆ XactLastCommitEnd

◆ XactLastRecEnd

◆ XLogArchiveCommand

char* XLogArchiveCommand = NULL

◆ XLogArchiveMode

◆ XLogArchiveTimeout

int XLogArchiveTimeout = 0

Definition at line 120 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by CheckArchiveTimeout(), and CheckpointerMain().

◆ XLOGbuffers

int XLOGbuffers = -1

Definition at line 119 of file xlog.c.

Referenced by check_wal_buffers(), XLOGShmemInit(), and XLOGShmemSize().

◆ XLogCtl